Ricoh MP c2051 SM PDF
Ricoh MP c2051 SM PDF
Ricoh MP c2051 SM PDF
5
Machine Code: D104/D106
17 December, 2010
Important Safety Notices
Responsibilities of the Customer Engineer
Customer Engineer
Maintenance shall be done only by trained customer engineers who have completed service training for
the machine and all optional devices designed for use with the machine.
Work carefully when lifting or moving the machine. If the machine is heavy, two or more customer
engineers may be required to prevent injuries (muscle strains, spinal injuries, etc.) or damage to the
machine if it is dropped or tipped over.
Personnel moving or working around the machine should always wear proper clothing and footwear.
Never wear loose fitting clothing or accessories (neckties, loose sweaters, bracelets, etc.) or casual
footwear (slippers, sandals, etc.) when lifting or moving the machine.
Always unplug the power cord from the power source before you move the product. Before you move
the product, arrange the power cord so it will not fall under the product.
1
Power
Always disconnect the power plug before doing any maintenance procedure. After switching off the
machine, power is still supplied to the main machine and other devices. To prevent electrical shock,
switch the machine off, wait for a few seconds, then unplug the machine from the power source.
Before you do any checks or adjustments after turning the machine off, work carefully to avoid injury.
After removing covers or opening the machine to do checks or adjustments, never touch electrical
components or moving parts (gears, timing belts, etc.).
After turning the machine on with any cover removed, keep your hands away from electrical
components and moving parts. Never touch the cover of the fusing unit, gears, timing belts, etc.
After installation, maintenance, or adjustment, always check the operation of the machine to make
sure that it is operating normally. This ensures that all shipping materials, protective materials, wires
and tags, metal brackets, etc., removed for installation, have been removed and that no tools remain
inside the machine. This also ensures that all release interlock switches have been restored to normal
operation.
Never use your fingers to check moving parts causing spurious noise. Never use your fingers to
lubricate moving parts while the machine is operating.
Special Tools
During Maintenance
General
Before you begin a maintenance procedure: 1) Switch the machine off, 2) Disconnect the power plug
from the power source, 3) Allow the machine to cool for at least 10 minutes.
2
Avoid touching the components inside the machine that are labeled as hot surfaces.
Safety Devices
Never remove any safety device unless it requires replacement. Always replace safety devices
immediately.
Never do any procedure that defeats the function of any safety device. Modification or removal of a
safety device (fuse, switch, etc.) could lead to a fire and personal injury. Always test the operation of
the machine to ensure that it is operating normally and safely after removal and replacement of any
safety device.
For replacements use only the correct fuses or circuit breakers rated for use with the machine. Using
replacement devices not designed for use with the machine could lead to a fire and personal injuries.
Organic Cleaners
During preventive maintenance, never use any organic cleaners (alcohol, etc.) other than those
described in the service manual.
Make sure the room is well ventilated before using any organic cleaner. Use organic solvents in small
amounts to avoid breathing the fumes and becoming nauseous.
Switch the machine off, unplug it, and allow it to cool before doing preventive maintenance. To avoid
fire or explosion, never use an organic cleaner near any part that generates heat.
Wash your hands thoroughly after cleaning parts with an organic cleaner to contamination of food,
drinks, etc. which could cause illness.
Clean the floor completely after accidental spillage of silicone oil or other materials to prevent slippery
surfaces that could cause accidents leading to hand or leg injuries. Use "My Ace" Silicone Oil Remover
(or dry rags) to soak up spills. For more details, please refer to Technical Bulletin "Silicone Oil
Removal" (A024-50).
Lithium Batteries
Always replace a lithium battery on a PCB with the same type of battery prescribed for use on that
board. Replacing a lithium battery with any type other than the one prescribed for use on the board
could lead to an explosion or damage to the PCB.
Never discard used batteries by mixing them with other trash. Remove them from the work site and
dispose of them in accordance with local laws and regulations regarding the disposal of such items.
3
Ozone Filters
Always replace ozone filters as soon as their service life expires (as described in the service manual).
An excessive amount of ozone can build up around machines that use ozone filters if they are not
replaced at the prescribed time. Excessive ozone could cause personnel working around the machine
to feel unwell.
Before serving the machine (especially when responding to a service call), always make sure that the
power plug has been inserted completely into the power source. A partially inserted plug could lead
to heat generation (due to a power surge caused by high resistance) and cause a fire or other
problems.
Always check the power plug and make sure that it is free of dust and lint. Clean it if necessary. A
dirty plug can generate heat which could cause a fire.
Inspect the length of the power cord for cuts or other damage. Replace the power cord if necessary.
A frayed or otherwise damaged power cord can cause a short circuit which could lead to a fire or
personal injury from electrical shock.
Check the length of the power cord between the machine and power supply. Make sure the power
cord is not coiled or wrapped around any object such as a table leg. Coiling the power cord can
cause excessive heat to build up and could cause a fire.
Make sure that the area around the power source is free of obstacles so the power cord can be
removed quickly in case of an emergency.
Make sure that the power cord is grounded (earthed) at the power source with the ground wire on
the plug.
Connect the power cord directly into the power source. Never use an extension cord.
When you disconnect the power plug from the power source, always pull on the plug, not the cable.
4
Toner or toner cartridges thrown into a fire can ignite or explode and cause serious injury. At the work
site always carefully wrap used toner and toner cartridges with plastic bags to avoid spillage before
disposal or removal.
Always dispose of used items (developer, toner, toner cartridges, OPC drums, etc.) in accordance
with the local laws and regulations regarding the disposal of such items.
To protect the environment, never dispose of this product or any kind of waste from consumables at
a household waste collection point. Dispose of these items at one of our dealers or at an authorized
collection site.
Return used selenium drums to the service center for handling in accordance with company policy
regarding the recycling or disposal of such items.
Work carefully when removing paper jams or replacing toner bottles or cartridges to avoid spilling
toner on clothing or the hands.
5
If toner is inhaled, immediately gargle with large amounts of cold water and move to a well ventilated
location. If there are signs of irritation or other problems, seek medical attention.
If toner gets on the skin, wash immediately with soap and cold running water.
If toner gets into the eyes, flush the eyes with cold running water or eye wash. If there are signs of
irritation or other problems, seek medical attention.
If toner is swallowed, drink a large amount of cold water to dilute the ingested toner. If there are signs
of any problem, seek medical attention.
If toner spills on clothing, wash the affected area immediately with soap and cold water. Never use
hot water! Hot water can cause toner to set and permanently stain fabric.
Always store toner and developer supplies such as toner and developer packages, cartridges, and
bottles (including used toner and empty bottles and cartridges) out of the reach of children.
Always store fresh toner supplies or empty bottles or cartridges in a cool, dry location that is not
exposed to direct sunlight.
Toner Disposal
Never attempt to incinerate toner, used toner, or empty toner containers (bottles or cartridges). Burning
toner can explode and scatter, causing serious burns.
Always wrap used toner and empty toner bottles and cartridges in plastic bags to avoid spillage.
Follow the local laws and regulations regarding the disposal of such items.
Dispose of used toner and toner cartridges at one of our dealers or at an authorized collection site.
Always dispose of used toner cartridges and toner bottles in accordance with the local laws and
regulations regarding the disposal of such items.
6
Safety Instructions for this Machine
7
2. Dispose of used toner, developer, and organic photoconductors in accordance with local regulations.
(These are non-toxic supplies.)
3. Dispose of replaced parts in accordance with local regulations.
4. When keeping used lithium batteries in order to dispose of them later, do not put more than 100
batteries per sealed box. Storing larger numbers or not sealing them apart may lead to chemical
reactions and heat build-up.
Laser Safety
The Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) prohibits the repair of laser-based optical units
in the field. The optical housing unit can only be repaired in a factory or at a location with the requisite
equipment. The laser subsystem is replaceable in the field by a qualified Customer Engineer. The laser
chassis is not repairable in the field. Customer engineers are therefore directed to return all chassis and
laser subsystems to the factory or service depot when replacement of the optical subsystem is required.
Use of controls, or adjustment, or performance of procedures other than those specified in this manual
may result in hazardous radiation exposure.
WARNING: Turn off the main switch before attempting any of the procedures in the Laser Optics
Housing Unit section. Laser beams can seriously damage your eyes.
CAUTION MARKING:
8
Symbols, Abbreviations and Trademarks
This manual uses several symbols and abbreviations. The meaning of those symbols and abbreviations are
as follows:
See or Refer to
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
E-ring
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United
States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of their
respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
9
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Important Safety Notices...................................................................................................................................1
Responsibilities of the Customer Engineer....................................................................................................1
Before Installation, Maintenance..................................................................................................................1
During Maintenance......................................................................................................................................2
After Installation, Servicing............................................................................................................................4
Special Safety Instructions for Toner.............................................................................................................5
Safety Instructions for this Machine...............................................................................................................7
Laser Safety.....................................................................................................................................................8
Symbols, Abbreviations and Trademarks.........................................................................................................9
Trademarks.....................................................................................................................................................9
1. Product Information
Specifications....................................................................................................................................................21
Machine Configuration....................................................................................................................................22
Machine D104/D106...............................................................................................................................22
Overview..........................................................................................................................................................25
Mechanical Component Layout.................................................................................................................25
Paper Path....................................................................................................................................................27
Drive Layout..................................................................................................................................................29
Guidance for Those Who are Familiar with Predecessor Products..............................................................30
2. Installation
Installation Requirements.................................................................................................................................31
Environment..................................................................................................................................................31
Machine Level..............................................................................................................................................32
Machine Space Requirements....................................................................................................................32
Power Requirements....................................................................................................................................33
Optional Unit Combinations............................................................................................................................34
Machine Options.........................................................................................................................................34
Controller Options.......................................................................................................................................35
Copier Installation............................................................................................................................................36
Power Sockets for Peripherals....................................................................................................................36
Installation Flow Chart.................................................................................................................................36
Accessory Check..........................................................................................................................................37
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................39
10
Moving the Machine...................................................................................................................................54
Transporting the Machine...........................................................................................................................54
Paper Feed Unit (D331)..................................................................................................................................56
Accessory Check..........................................................................................................................................56
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................56
Paper Feed Unit (D425)..................................................................................................................................59
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................59
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................59
Caster Table (D488)........................................................................................................................................62
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................62
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................62
ARDF (D366)....................................................................................................................................................65
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................65
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................65
Platen Cover Installation (G329)....................................................................................................................69
Side Tray (D427).............................................................................................................................................70
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................70
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................71
1-Bin Tray Unit (D426)....................................................................................................................................74
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................74
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................74
Shift Tray Unit (D428)......................................................................................................................................78
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................78
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................78
Internal Finisher (D429)...................................................................................................................................81
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................81
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................82
Punch Unit (D390)...........................................................................................................................................88
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................88
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................89
Envelope Feeder EF3010 (D559)...............................................................................................................101
Component Check....................................................................................................................................101
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................101
11
Card Reader Bracket Type C5501 (D547)................................................................................................103
Component Check....................................................................................................................................103
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................104
USB2.0/SD Slot Type G (D556).................................................................................................................106
Accessory Check.......................................................................................................................................106
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................106
Testing the SD Card/USB Slot.................................................................................................................110
Mechanical Counter (NA Only)..................................................................................................................112
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................112
Key Counter Bracket......................................................................................................................................114
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................114
Key Counter Interface Unit............................................................................................................................116
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................116
Anti-Condensation Heater............................................................................................................................118
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................118
Tray Heater....................................................................................................................................................122
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................122
Controller Options.........................................................................................................................................131
Overview....................................................................................................................................................131
SD Card Appli Move................................................................................................................................132
PostScript 3................................................................................................................................................134
File Format Converter................................................................................................................................136
IEEE1284...................................................................................................................................................137
IEEE 802.11 a/g, g (Wireless LAN).......................................................................................................138
Bluetooth....................................................................................................................................................142
PictBridge...................................................................................................................................................143
Browser Unit Type E..................................................................................................................................144
Gigabit Ethernet.........................................................................................................................................146
Check All Connections..............................................................................................................................148
3. Preventive Maintenance
Maintenance Tables......................................................................................................................................149
PM Parts Settings............................................................................................................................................150
Before Removing the Old PM Parts.........................................................................................................150
12
After Installing the New PM parts............................................................................................................151
Preparation before Operation Check......................................................................................................151
Operation Check.......................................................................................................................................151
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Beforehand.....................................................................................................................................................153
Special Tools..................................................................................................................................................154
Image Adjustment..........................................................................................................................................155
Scanning....................................................................................................................................................155
ARDF...........................................................................................................................................................156
Registration................................................................................................................................................158
Erase Margin Adjustment..........................................................................................................................159
Color Registration......................................................................................................................................160
Printer Gamma Correction........................................................................................................................161
Exterior Covers...............................................................................................................................................165
PCDU Toner Collection Bottle..................................................................................................................165
Front Door..................................................................................................................................................165
ITB Cleaning Unit Cover...........................................................................................................................166
Left Cover...................................................................................................................................................167
Rear Cover.................................................................................................................................................168
Rear Lower Cover......................................................................................................................................168
Dust Filter....................................................................................................................................................169
Right Rear Cover.......................................................................................................................................169
Operation Panel........................................................................................................................................170
Touch Panel Position Adjustment..............................................................................................................170
Inner Right Cover.......................................................................................................................................171
Inner Cover................................................................................................................................................172
Front Right Cover.......................................................................................................................................172
Right Upper Cover ...................................................................................................................................173
Left Frame and Left Frame Rear Cover....................................................................................................173
Paper Exit Cover........................................................................................................................................174
Inverter Tray...............................................................................................................................................174
Inner Tray...................................................................................................................................................175
Inner Rear Cover.......................................................................................................................................175
13
Scanner Unit...................................................................................................................................................176
Exposure Glass..........................................................................................................................................176
Original Length Sensors............................................................................................................................178
Exposure Lamp..........................................................................................................................................179
Scanner Motor...........................................................................................................................................182
Sensor Board Unit (SBU)..........................................................................................................................183
Exposure Lamp Stabilizer.........................................................................................................................184
Scanner HP Sensor....................................................................................................................................184
Platen Cover Sensor..................................................................................................................................185
Front Scanner Wire...................................................................................................................................185
Rear Scanner Wire....................................................................................................................................191
Laser Optics....................................................................................................................................................194
Caution Decal Location............................................................................................................................194
Laser Unit....................................................................................................................................................194
Polygon Mirror Motor...............................................................................................................................199
Image Creation..............................................................................................................................................201
PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit)...................................................................................201
Drum Unit and Development Unit............................................................................................................202
Toner Hopper Unit.....................................................................................................................................205
Toner Supply Motor..................................................................................................................................208
Toner Collection Motor.............................................................................................................................210
PCDU Toner Collection Bottle Full Sensor...............................................................................................212
PCDU Toner Collection Bottle Set Switch................................................................................................212
RFID Board.................................................................................................................................................213
Image Transfer...............................................................................................................................................215
ITB Cleaning Unit.......................................................................................................................................215
ITB Toner Collection Bottle Full Sensor....................................................................................................216
ITB (Image Transfer Belt) Unit...................................................................................................................216
ITB Unit Motor............................................................................................................................................217
Image Transfer Belt....................................................................................................................................218
ITB Contact Motor.....................................................................................................................................222
ITB Contact Sensor....................................................................................................................................224
Paper Transfer................................................................................................................................................225
14
PTR (Paper Transfer Roller) Unit...............................................................................................................225
Paper Transfer Unit Full-Open..................................................................................................................226
ID Sensor Board........................................................................................................................................227
PTR Contact Motor....................................................................................................................................229
PTR Contact Sensor...................................................................................................................................231
Temperature and Humidity Sensor..........................................................................................................232
Drive Unit........................................................................................................................................................233
Gear Unit...................................................................................................................................................233
Registration Motor.....................................................................................................................................235
Paper Feed Motor: T1...............................................................................................................................236
Paper Feed Motor: T2...............................................................................................................................237
Drum Motor: CMY....................................................................................................................................237
Development Motor: CMY.......................................................................................................................238
Drum/Development Motor: K..................................................................................................................238
Development Clutch: K.............................................................................................................................239
Fusing/Paper Exit Motor..........................................................................................................................239
Fusing..............................................................................................................................................................242
Fusing Unit..................................................................................................................................................242
Entrance Guide Plate................................................................................................................................243
Stripper Plate.............................................................................................................................................244
Exit Guide Plate Cleaning Procedure......................................................................................................246
Fusing Gear Shafts Lubrication Procedure..............................................................................................247
Heating Roller Fusing Lamp......................................................................................................................248
Heating Roller Unit....................................................................................................................................249
Pressure Roller............................................................................................................................................252
Heating Roller Thermostats.......................................................................................................................254
Heating Roller Thermistor..........................................................................................................................255
Pressure Roller Thermistor ........................................................................................................................256
Thermopile.................................................................................................................................................258
Cleaning Unit (Option) Installation Procedure........................................................................................260
Paper Feed.....................................................................................................................................................262
Paper Tray..................................................................................................................................................262
Feed Roller.................................................................................................................................................262
15
Friction Pad................................................................................................................................................263
Paper Size Switch......................................................................................................................................264
Paper End Sensor......................................................................................................................................265
Registration Sensor....................................................................................................................................266
Vertical Transport Sensor .........................................................................................................................268
Paper Exit........................................................................................................................................................272
Junction Gate Solenoid Fan.....................................................................................................................272
Paper Exit Unit...........................................................................................................................................272
Fusing Exit Sensor......................................................................................................................................274
Paper Exit Sensor.......................................................................................................................................275
Inverter Sensor...........................................................................................................................................276
Inverter Motor............................................................................................................................................277
Fusing Front Fan.........................................................................................................................................278
Duplex Unit.....................................................................................................................................................280
Duplex Unit................................................................................................................................................280
Duplex Entrance Sensor............................................................................................................................281
Duplex Exit Sensor....................................................................................................................................283
Duplex Entrance Motor.............................................................................................................................284
Duplex Exit Motor.....................................................................................................................................285
By-pass Motor...........................................................................................................................................285
By-pass Tray Unit.......................................................................................................................................286
By-pass Paper Length Sensor ..................................................................................................................287
By-Pass Paper Size Sensor.......................................................................................................................288
By-pass Paper End Sensor........................................................................................................................290
By-pass Feed Roller...................................................................................................................................290
By-pass Tray HP Sensor............................................................................................................................291
Electrical Components...................................................................................................................................292
Boards........................................................................................................................................................292
Controller Box Cover ...............................................................................................................................293
Controller Box............................................................................................................................................294
BCU............................................................................................................................................................294
HDD............................................................................................................................................................296
IPU Board...................................................................................................................................................297
16
Controller Box Fan....................................................................................................................................298
Fusing Rear Fan.........................................................................................................................................299
DRB.............................................................................................................................................................300
SDVDB........................................................................................................................................................300
PSU.............................................................................................................................................................301
HVPS: TTS Board.......................................................................................................................................302
HVPS: CB Board........................................................................................................................................302
Controller Board........................................................................................................................................303
NVRAM Replacement Procedure............................................................................................................307
5. System Maintenance
Service Program Mode.................................................................................................................................311
SP Tables....................................................................................................................................................311
Types of SP Modes....................................................................................................................................311
Remarks......................................................................................................................................................315
Main SP Tables-1..........................................................................................................................................317
SP1-XXX (Feed).........................................................................................................................................317
Main SP Tables-2..........................................................................................................................................338
SP2-XXX (Drum).........................................................................................................................................338
Main SP Tables-3..........................................................................................................................................365
SP3-XXX (Process).....................................................................................................................................365
Main SP Tables-4..........................................................................................................................................400
SP4-XXX (Scanner)....................................................................................................................................400
Main SP Tables-5..........................................................................................................................................412
SP5-XXX (Mode).......................................................................................................................................412
Main SP Tables-6..........................................................................................................................................469
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)...............................................................................................................................469
Main SP Tables-7..........................................................................................................................................472
SP7-XXX (Data Log)..................................................................................................................................472
Main SP Tables-8..........................................................................................................................................504
Input and Output Check Tables...............................................................................................................504
Main SP Tables-9..........................................................................................................................................520
Printer Service Mode.................................................................................................................................520
Scanner SP Mode.....................................................................................................................................528
17
Firmware Update...........................................................................................................................................530
Type of Firmware.......................................................................................................................................530
Before You Begin.......................................................................................................................................531
Updating Firmware ..................................................................................................................................532
Updating the LCDC for the Operation Panel..........................................................................................534
Handling Firmware Update Errors...........................................................................................................535
Java VM Updating Procedure..................................................................................................................536
App2Me Updating Procedure.................................................................................................................537
Brower Unit Updating Procedure.............................................................................................................538
Installing Another Language.........................................................................................................................540
Reboot/System Setting Reset.......................................................................................................................543
Software Reset...........................................................................................................................................543
System Settings and Copy Setting Reset..................................................................................................543
Controller Self-Diagnostics...........................................................................................................................545
Overview....................................................................................................................................................545
SD Card Appli Move....................................................................................................................................547
Overview....................................................................................................................................................547
Move Exec.................................................................................................................................................548
Undo Exec..................................................................................................................................................549
Downloading Stamp Data............................................................................................................................550
NVRAM Data Upload/Download..............................................................................................................551
Uploading Content of NVRAM to an SD card.......................................................................................551
Downloading an SD Card to NVRAM....................................................................................................551
Address Book Upload/Download..............................................................................................................553
Information List...........................................................................................................................................553
Download..................................................................................................................................................553
Upload.......................................................................................................................................................554
Using the Debug Log.....................................................................................................................................555
Overview....................................................................................................................................................555
Switching ON and Setting UP Save Debug Log.....................................................................................555
Retrieving the Debug Log from the HDD.................................................................................................559
Recording Errors Manually.......................................................................................................................559
Card Save Function.......................................................................................................................................560
18
Overview....................................................................................................................................................560
Procedure...................................................................................................................................................560
6. Troubleshooting
SC Tables.......................................................................................................................................................565
Service Call Conditions.............................................................................................................................565
SC1xx: Scanning.......................................................................................................................................568
SC 2xx: Exposure......................................................................................................................................572
SC3xx: Image Processing 1..................................................................................................................577
SC4xx: Image Processing - 2...................................................................................................................582
SC5xx: Paper Feed and Fusing................................................................................................................586
SC6xx: Device Communication...............................................................................................................599
SC7xx: Peripherals....................................................................................................................................608
SC8xx: Overall System.............................................................................................................................614
SC9xx: Miscellaneous..............................................................................................................................632
Process Control Error Conditions..................................................................................................................637
Developer Initialization Result..................................................................................................................637
Process Control Self-Check Result............................................................................................................638
Line Position Adjustment Result.................................................................................................................640
Troubleshooting Guide..................................................................................................................................642
Image Quality............................................................................................................................................642
Line Position Adjustment............................................................................................................................644
Image Problems at Regular Intervals.......................................................................................................650
Sub-scan Magnification Error..................................................................................................................651
Trapezoid Image Adjustment...................................................................................................................654
Loud Squeaking Noise from PCDU.........................................................................................................657
Loud Noise from the Paper Tray..............................................................................................................660
Grainy Image............................................................................................................................................660
Toner Supply Error....................................................................................................................................668
Paper Jam Troubleshooting......................................................................................................................669
No Feed Paper Jam from PFU..................................................................................................................682
Setting for Special Paper 4, 5 and 6 Mode...........................................................................................683
Jam Detection.................................................................................................................................................693
Paper Jam Display.....................................................................................................................................693
19
Jam Codes and Display Codes................................................................................................................694
Electrical Component Defects.......................................................................................................................699
Sensors ......................................................................................................................................................699
Blown Fuse Conditions..............................................................................................................................703
Scanner Test Mode........................................................................................................................................705
SBU Test Mode..........................................................................................................................................705
IPU Test Mode...........................................................................................................................................705
7. Energy Saving
Energy Save...................................................................................................................................................707
Energy Saver Modes................................................................................................................................707
Energy Save Effectiveness........................................................................................................................708
Paper Save.....................................................................................................................................................710
Effectiveness of Duplex/Combine Function............................................................................................710
INDEX...........................................................................................................................................................715
20
1. Product Information
Specifications 1
See "Appendices" for the following information:
General Specifications
Supported Paper Sizes
Software Accessories
Optional Equipment
21
1. Product Information
Machine Configuration
1 Machine D104/D106
Machine Call
Item Remarks
Code out
D104/
Mainframe [1] D104: C1.5a, D106: C1.5c
D106
22
Machine Configuration
Machine Call
Item Remarks
Code out
Two-tray paper
D331 [6]
feed unit One from [6], [7], and [8];
The one-tray PFU [6] requires [8].
One-tray paper
D425 [7] If neither [6] nor [7] is installed, install [8] if required by the
feed unit
customer.
Caster Table D448 [8]
SAF memory:
Memory Unit Type B G578
Requires the Fax Option.
Hand Set B433 For NA model only: Requires the Fax Option.
Wireless LAN
D377-01, 02
(IEEE 802.11a/g)
Bluetooth B826
23
1. Product Information
24
Overview
Overview
Mechanical Component Layout 1
25
1. Product Information
1. Scanner HP sensor
16. Feed roller: T1
2. 2nd carriage
17. Vertical transport roller 2
3. 1st carriage
1 4. Original length sensor
18. Feed roller: T1
19. Vertical transport roller 3
5. Lens
20. Tray 2
6. SBU
21. Tray 1
7. Inverter roller
22. Laser unit
8. Paper exit roller
23. Drum unit
9. Junction gate
24. Development unit
10. Duplex unit
25. ITB cleaning unit
11. Fusing unit
26. ITB roller
12. PTR (Paper transfer roller) unit
27. Toner bottle
13. Registration roller
28. ITB (Image Transfer Belt) unit
14. Vertical transport roller 1
29. Inner Tray
15. By-pass feed roller
26
Overview
Paper Path
With options
1
27
1. Product Information
Without options
28
Overview
Drive Layout
29
1. Product Information
D104/D106 D038/D041
30
2. Installation
Installation Requirements
Environment 2
31
2. Installation
The toner bottle must be kept at a temperature of 35C (95F) or less. Be careful not to leave the
toner bottle in a hot place when transporting or storing it.
Machine Level
This machine, which uses high voltage power sources, can generate ozone gas. High ozone density
is harmful to human health. Therefore, the machine must be installed in a well-ventilated room.
32
Installation Requirements
Power Requirements
33
2. Installation
5 Platen cover
One from No.5 or No.6
6 ARDF (Standard)
10 Internal finisher
12 Fax unit -
34
Optional Unit Combinations
Controller Options
1 IEEE 802.11a/g
2 IEEE 1284
2
3 Bluetooth One from six items (I/F Slot)
5 Gigabit Ethernet
6 PostScript 3
One of these (SD card slot 1)
7 PictBridge
35
2. Installation
Copier Installation
Power Sockets for Peripherals
CAUTION
2
Rating voltage for peripherals.
Make sure to plug the cables into the correct sockets.
[1] ARDF: Rating voltage output connector for accessory Max. DC24V
[2] Finisher: Rating voltage output connector for accessory Max. DC24V
36
Copier Installation
*1: The shift tray should be installed first if you want to install the shift tray with the 1-bin tray at the same
time.
Accessory Check
2. EU Safety Sheet 1
-27
3. WEEE 1
37
2. Installation
38
Copier Installation
Installation Procedure
Remove the tapes from the development units before you turn the main switch on. The development
units can be severely damaged if you do not remove the tapes.
Put the machine on the paper tray unit first if you install an optional paper tray unit at the same time. Then
install the machine and other options.
Keep the shipping retainers after you install the machine. You may need them in the future if you
transport the machine to another location.
Hold the handles [A] and grips [B] when lifting or moving the machine.
39
2. Installation
Do not hold the right bottom frame [C] of the machine when lifting or moving the machine. If you do
so, the right bottom frame [C] of the machine may be bent.
40
Copier Installation
2. Open the DF left cover [A], and then remove all the tapes and retainer on the ADF if the ADF has
been installed.
3. Open the ADF unit, and then remove all the tapes and plastic package.
Keep the SD card for the Java VM and the decal sheet for the tray number and paper size. These
items will be used in the later step.
4. Pull out the tray 1 and 2 [A], and then remove all the tapes and retainers in the tray 1 and 2.
41
2. Installation
For the EU models, the scanner unit stay cannot be inserted in the cutout on the inner tray. You
must bring this stay back to your depot.
42
Copier Installation
43
2. Installation
13. Attach the handle cover [A] to the front side of the duplex unit.
1. Open the front door [A], and then remove the PCDU toner collection bottle [B].
2. Remove the ITB lock lever [A] from the PCDU toner collection bottle.
Keep this lever for the later step.
44
Copier Installation
4. Remove the all tapes [A] from the toner hopper units.
The toner hopper cover [B] can be removed with tape [C].
Make sure that the all toner hopper covers are removed, when removing all tapes.
45
2. Installation
If the toner hopper shutter is not fully closed and the inlet [B] of the toner hopper unit is visible,
the toner bottle cannot be installed properly.
6. Attach the ITB lock lever [A] to the ITB contact arm [B].
The arrow mark on the top of the ITB lock lever should be pointed to the machine.
This lock lever will not be removed once it is attached to the ITB contact arm.
7. Press the ITB lock lever [C] and turn it down as shown above.
8. Reinstall the PCDU toner collection bottle.
46
Copier Installation
9. Take out the toner bottle package [A] from the toner bottle box [B].
10. Unpack the toner bottle package, and then remove the tape [C].
11. Shake each toner bottle five or six times.
47
2. Installation
13. Push the toner bottle, and then turn each one to the right (clockwise).
Paper Trays
1. Pull each paper tray [A] out. Then adjust the side guides and end guide to match the paper size.
To move the side guides, first pull out the tray fully. Then push down the green lock at the rear
inside the tray.
48
Copier Installation
1. Attach the correct emblem [A] and the cover [B] to the front door [C] of the machine, if the emblem
is not attached.
If you want to change the emblem that has been already attached, remove the panel with an
object (not a sharp object) as shown [D], and then install the correct emblem.
2. Attach the correct paper tray number and size decals to the paper trays [E].
Paper tray number and size decals are also used for the optional paper tray or the optional LCT.
Keep these decals for use with these optional units.
49
2. Installation
8. Remove the instruction guide sheet [A], and make sure the SMC report [B] is stored as shown above.
Then replace the instruction guide sheet.
You must select one of the counter methods (developments/prints) in accordance with the contract
( SP5045-001).
Counting method
50
Copier Installation
2
Settings for @Remote Service
Prepare and check the following check points before you visit the customer site. For details, ask the
@Remote key person.
Check points before making @Remote settings
1. The setting of SP5816-201 in the mainframe must be "0".
2. Print the SMC with SP5990-002 and then check if a device ID2 (SP5811-003) must be correctly
programmed.
6 spaces must be put between the 3-digit prefix and the following 8-digit number (e.g.
xxx______xxxxxxxx).
ID2 (SP5811-003) and the serial number (SP5811-001) must be the same (e.g. ID2:
A01______23456789 = serial No. A0123456789)
3. The following settings must be correctly programmed.
Proxy server IP address (SP5816-063)
Proxy server Port number (SP5816-064)
Proxy User ID (SP5816-065)
Proxy Password (SP5816-066)
4. Get a Request Number
Execute the @Remote Settings
1. Enter the SP mode.
2. Input the Request number which you have obtained from @Remote Center GUI, and then enter [OK]
with SP5816-202.
3. Confirm the Request number, and then click [EXECUTE] with SP5816-203.
4. Check the confirmation result with SP5816-204.
0 Succeeded -
51
2. Installation
5. Make sure that the screen displays the Location Information with SP5816-205 only when it has been
input at the Center GUI.
6. Click [EXECUTE] to execute the registration with SP5816-206.
7. Check the registration result with SP5816-207.
0 Succeeded -
52
Copier Installation
53
2. Installation
This section shows you how to manually move the machine from one floor to another floor. See the section
"Transporting the Machine" if you have to pack the machine and move it a longer distance.
Remove all trays from the optional paper feed unit.
Main Frame
1. Do SP 4806-001 to move the scanner carriage from the home position. This prevents dust from falling
into the machine during transportation.
2. Make sure there is no paper left in the paper trays. Then fix down the bottom plates with a sheet of
paper and tape.
3. Do one of the following:
54
Copier Installation
After you move the machine, Make sure you do the "Auto Color Registration" as follows. This
optimizes color registration.
Do the "Forced Line Position Adj. Mode c" (SP2-111-3). 2
Then do the "Forced Line Position Adj. Mode a" (SP2-111-1).
To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is
displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.
Make sure that the side fences in the trays are correctly positioned to prevent color registration
errors.
55
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
2
No. Description Qty
2 Screw - M4 x 10 4
3 Securing Bracket 2
Installation Procedure
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
The handles of the main machine for lifting must be inserted inside the machine and locked, unless
these handles are used for the installation or relocation of the main machine.
You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one
person, and may cause human injury or property damage.
56
Paper Feed Unit (D331)
When installing the copier, be careful not to pinch the cable [C].
57
2. Installation
7. Remove the 1st and 2nd paper trays [A] and secure the paper tray unit with two screws (M4 x 10)
[B].
8. Reinstall all the paper trays.
9. Attach the appropriate paper tray number decal and paper size decal to each handle of the trays.
The paper tray number and size decal sheet is in the accessory box of the main machine.
10. Rotate the adjuster [A] until the machine cannot be pushed across the floor.
11. Load paper into the paper trays and select the proper paper size.
12. Turn on the main switch.
13. Adjust the registration for each tray ( Image Adjustment).
For tray 3, use SP1002-004
For tray 4, use SP1002-005
14. Check the machines operation and copy quality.
58
Paper Feed Unit (D425)
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
2
No. Description Qty
2 Securing bracket 2
Installation Procedure
Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation
procedure.
You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one
person, and may cause human injury or property damage.
Do not lift the copier with the paper feed unit installed. The handle and grips may be damaged.
The one-tray paper feed unit must be installed on the caster table (D448). Prepare the caster table
first before installing this unit.
59
2. Installation
For details about the installation of the caster table, see the Caster Table (D488) installation
procedure.
Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine.
60
Paper Feed Unit (D425)
6. Remove the rear connector cover [A] of the main machine (rivet screw x 1).
7. Connect the harness [B] to the main machine.
8. Reinstall the rear connector cover [A] (rivet screw x 1).
9. Remove tray 1 and 2 of the machine.
10. Fasten the screws (M4 x 10) [C].
11. Reinstall all trays.
12. Attach the securing brackets [D] (M4 x 10; x 1 each).
13. Load paper into the paper feed unit.
14. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
15. Adjust the registration for each tray ( Image Adjustment).
Use SP1002-004
16. Check the paper feed unit operation and copy quality.
61
2. Installation
2 Pin 2
3 Step Screw 2
Installation Procedure
62
Caster Table (D488)
Use the screw holes [A] and [C] if the mainframe is directly installed on the caster table.
Use the screw holes [B] and [C] if the one-tray paper feed unit (D425) is installed on the caster
table.
3. Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine, if the copier is to be installed on the caster table.
Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine.
4. Lift the copier or one-tray paper feed unit [C], and then install it on the caster table [D].
5. Pull out tray 2 of the mainframe or the tray of the one-tray paper feed unit.
6. Secure the machine or one-tray paper feed unit to the caster table (step screw x 2)
63
2. Installation
64
ARDF (D366)
ARDF (D366)
Component Check
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
2
No. Description Qty
1 ARDF 1
2 Stamp Cartridge 1
3 Knob Screw 2
4 Stud Screw 2
Installation Procedure
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
65
2. Installation
2. Insert the two stud screws [A] on the top of the machine.
3. Mount the ARDF [A] by aligning the screw keyholes [B] of the ARDF support plate over the stud screws.
4. Slide the ARDF toward the front of the machine.
5. Secure the ARDF with the two knob screws [C].
66
ARDF (D366)
7. Peel off the platen sheet [A] and place it on the exposure glass.
8. Align the rear left corner (of the platen sheet) with the corner [B] on the exposure glass.
9. Close the ARDF.
10. Open the ARDF and check that the platen sheet is correctly attached.
67
2. Installation
11. Attach the decal [A] to the top cover as shown. Choose the language that you want.
12. Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the machine, and then check the ARDF operation.
13. Make a full size copy. Check that the registrations (side-to-side and leading edge) and image skew
are correct. If they are not, adjust the registrations and image skew (see "Image Adjustment" in the
"Replacements and Adjustments" chapter).
68
Platen Cover Installation (G329)
69
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
2
No. Description Qty
2 Side Tray 1
3 Decal: Push 1
5 Screw: M3x8 1
6 Tray Stopper 1
70
Side Tray (D427)
Installation Procedure
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
4. Close the side tray paper exit unit [A], and then connect the harness [B] to the machine.
5. Install the side tray paper exit unit ( x 2: removed in step 3).
71
2. Installation
8. Attach the Push door decal [A] to the top front edge of the duplex unit cover.
9. Close the duplex unit, and then attach the Push decal [A] to the duplex unit cover.
72
Side Tray (D427)
73
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
2
No. Description Qty
1 Tray 1
4 Screw (M3 x 8) 1
Installation Procedure
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
74
1-Bin Tray Unit (D426)
If both the shift tray unit and the 1-bin tray unit are installed in the mainframe at the same time, install
the shift tray unit first. Installing the shift tray unit after the 1-bin tray unit may be difficult.
1. Remove all tapes.
75
2. Installation
9. Install the tray [A] (with the tray support bar) in the machine.
76
1-Bin Tray Unit (D426)
10. Attach the tray support cover [B] ( x 2: M3x8 in the accessories and one screw removed in step
7).
11. Reassemble the machine.
12. Turn on the main power switch of the machine, and check the 1-bin tray unit operation.
77
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
2
No. Description Qty
Installation Procedure
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
If both the shift tray unit and the 1-bin tray unit are installed in the mainframe at the same time, install
the shift tray unit first. Installing the shift tray unit after the 1-bin tray unit may be difficult.
1. Remove all tapes.
78
Shift Tray Unit (D428)
4. Put the shift tray [A] in the machine, and then connect the harness to the connector [B] on the inner
rear frame.
If the shift tray is difficult to install in the mainframe, remove the paper exit cover [C] first ( x
1).
79
2. Installation
80
Internal Finisher (D429)
Component Check
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
2
No. Description Qty
1 Internal Finisher 1
2 Inverter Unit 1
4 Screw: M3x10 3
5 Screw: M3x6 12
6 Guide Rail 1
7 Inverter Cover 1
8 Left Cover 1
81
2. Installation
Installation Procedure
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
82
Internal Finisher (D429)
7. Open the duplex unit [A], and then remove the front right cover [B] ( x 1).
83
2. Installation
10. Attach the left cover [A] ( x 2: M3x6, one screw removed in step 8).
If the punch unit (D390) is to be installed with this finisher (D429) at the same time, skip this procedure
below, and then refer to the installation procedure of "Punch Unit (D390)".
84
Internal Finisher (D429)
2. Insert two joint pins [A] into the two holes in the inner rear bracket.
3. Fully attach the front side [B] of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of the mainframe after inserting
the two joint pins ( x 1: M3x6).
Insert the two joint pins before attaching the front side of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of
the mainframe. Otherwise, paper jams may occur between the paper exit unit and inverter unit.
85
2. Installation
6. Install the internal finisher [A] from the left side of the machine.
86
Internal Finisher (D429)
7. Insert the rear rail pins [A] into the frame of the machine ( x 1: M3x6).
8. Push the internal finisher [A] and connect the cable [B] to the power socket of the machine.
9. Reassemble the machine.
10. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
11. Check the internal finisher operation.
87
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
2
No. Description Qty
1 Punch Unit 1
3 Drawer Connector 1
4 Bracket 1
6 Punch Cover 1
88
Punch Unit (D390)
Installation Procedure
If the internal finisher has not already been installed, skip the "Removing the Internal Finisher" section, and
go to the "Preparing the Punch Unit before Installing the Internal Finisher" section. Also do "Preparing before
Installing the Internal Finisher" in the "Internal Finisher (D429)" section.
If the internal finisher has already been installed, you must remove it first. Start from the "Removing the
Internal Finisher" section. 2
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
2. Open the right door [A], and then remove the front right cover [B] ( x 1).
3. Disconnect the cable [A] from the power socket of the machine, and then pull out the internal finisher
[B].
89
2. Installation
90
Punch Unit (D390)
7. Pull the inverter unit [A] toward the front side ( x 1: M3x6).
91
2. Installation
1. Remove the inverter right bracket [A] from the inverter unit ( x 4).
2. To remove screw [B], open guide plate [C].
3. Remove the positioning pin bracket [A] from the inverter right bracket ( x 2).
4. Attach the inverter right bracket [A] to the punch unit [B] ( x 1: M3x6).
92
Punch Unit (D390)
5. Slide the inverter small guide [A] to the front side (arrow direction), and then remove it ( x 1).
6. Remove all the tapes on the punch unit.
7. Attach the inverter unit [A] to the punch unit [B], and then secure the inverter unit with the punch unit
( x 4 removed in step 1).
8. Attach the drawer connector [A] of the punch unit to the rear bracket of the inverter unit ( x2
removed in step 3).
9. Attach the clamp [B] to the rear bracket of the inverter unit.
93
2. Installation
2. Insert the two joint pins [A] (this picture does not show the two joint pins) into the two holes in the inner
rear bracket.
3. Fully attach the front side [B] of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of the mainframe after inserting
two joint pins ( x 1: M3x6).
Insert the two joint pins before attaching the front side of the inverter unit to the paper exit unit of
the mainframe. Otherwise, paper jams may occur between the paper exit unit and inverter unit.
94
Punch Unit (D390)
4. Remove the stopper [A] from the guide rail, and then attach with the screw holes [B] (these screw
holes must be used when the internal finisher is installed with the punch unit).
5. Install the guide rail [A] on the front edge of the inner bottom plate ( x 2).
95
2. Installation
1. Remove the left rear cover [A] and the rear cover [B] of the internal finisher ( x 2 each).
2. Attach the drawer connector [A] to the rear bracket of the finisher.
3. Connect the harnesses [B] to the connectors [C] on the main board.
Black harness connector to CN16
Gray harness connector to CN17
4. Reinstall the rear cover (removed in step 1) ( x 2).
96
Punch Unit (D390)
3. Attach the bracket [A] ( x 2); this bracket is for the internal finisher when used with the punch unit.
97
2. Installation
4. Remove the output tray lower cover [A]; this cover is for the internal finisher without the punch unit
( x 3).
5. Attach the output tray lower cover [A]; this cover is for the internal finisher when used with the punch
unit ( x 3).
98
Punch Unit (D390)
Note
The two projections [A] on the output tray lower cover (this plate is actually attached to the output
tray lower cover) must be inserted along the two guide rails [B] inside the output tray unit.
Push the slide plate [A] to check if the output tray lower cover is correctly installed. The left side
picture shows the correct result and the right side picture shows the incorrect result.
99
2. Installation
100
Envelope Feeder EF3010 (D559)
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
2
No. Description Qty
1 Envelope Feeder 1
Installation Procedure
This tray can be only installed in tray 1 of the copier. Do not install this tray in trays other than tray 1.
Otherwise, paper jam or other paper problem may occur.
1. Remove all tapes and red tag from the envelope feeder.
101
2. Installation
5. Install the envelope feeder [A] into tray 1 of the main machine.
6. Secure two screws at both tray guides.
7. Close the tray 1, and then turn on the machine.
102
Card Reader Bracket Type C5501 (D547)
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
2
No. Description Qty
1 Screw: M3 x 8 1
2 Screw: M3 x 14*1 1
3 Screw: M3 x 25 1
4 Tapping Screw: M3 x 10 2
5 Upper Tray 1
6 Lower Tray 1
7 Tray Bracket 3
8 Clamp 5
103
2. Installation
Installation Procedure
104
Card Reader Bracket Type C5501 (D547)
The smart card reader must be placed on this card reader tray. If not, some antenna or transmitter in
the main machine may be interrupted.
105
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
2
No. Description Qty
1 USB2.0/SD Slot 1
2 Ground Plate 1
3 USB Cable 1
4 Screw: M3 x 6 blue 1
5 Screw: M3 x 8 4
6 Decal 1
7 Clamp 1
*1: If the PostScript 3 option is used in this machine, this card is not necessary.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the USB cable [B] to the USB slot [A] in the USB2.0/SD Slot unit.
2. Attach the ground plate [C] to the bracket of the USB2.0/SD Slot ( x 1: M3x6 blue).
106
USB2.0/SD Slot Type G (D556)
107
2. Installation
2
7. Make four holes in the scanner left cover with a screwdriver as shown [A].
Smooth the four holes in the scanner left cover as shown [B].
8. Route the USB cable [A] through the gaps in the left scanner cover.
9. Secure the USB2.0/SD Slot [B] with the left scanner cover as shown above ( x 4: M3x8).
108
USB2.0/SD Slot Type G (D556)
10. Attach the scanner left cover [A] to the mainframe ( x 2).
11. Connect the USB cable [B] to USB-A (this is the USB slot closest to the front side of the machine) as
shown above.
Make sure that the USB cable is inserted in USB-A (front side).
12. Attach the clamp [A] to the left middle area of the rear cover.
13. Wind the USB cable [B] two or three times not to interrupt the other slots, and then clamp the cable
loops ( x 1).
If PostScript 3 is already installed, go to step 23. If not, follow the steps from 14 to 22.
14. Remove the SD slot cover ( x 1), and move the SD card from SD slot 1 to SD slot 2.
15. Insert the PDF direct card in SD slot 1.
16. Plug in and turn on the mainframe.
109
2. Installation
25. Attach the decal [A] to the USB2.0/SD Slot as shown above.
110
USB2.0/SD Slot Type G (D556)
7. Press [OK].
8. Press the [Start] key.
When writing is complete, a confirmation message appears.
9. Press [Exit].
10. Remove the memory device from the media slot.
Do not remove the memory device while writing is in process. 2
111
2. Installation
2 Installation Procedure
4. Remove the cutout [A] in the rear lower cover with nippers.
5. Attach the mechanical counter [A] to the bracket [B] and connect the harness to each mechanical
counter as shown above.
The one [C] of two harnesses is not used in this model.
112
Mechanical Counter (NA Only)
113
2. Installation
2 Handset (B433)
Installation Procedure
1. Hold the key counter plate nuts [A] on the inside of the key counter bracket [B] and insert the key
counter holder [C].
2. Secure the key counter holder to the bracket ( x 2).
3. Install the key counter cover [D] ( x 2).
4. Rear cover ( p.168)
114
Key Counter Bracket
6. Peel off double sided tape on the key counter bracket, and attach the key counter to the scanner left
cover.
115
2. Installation
116
Key Counter Interface Unit
7. Connect and route the key counter cable [A] to the connector on the key counter interface board as
shown above (ground screw x 1, x 6).
8. Connect and route the harness [B] to the connector on the key counter interface board and connector
CN216 [C] on the BCU ( x 5)
9. Pull the key counter cable through from the cutout and connect it to the connector [A] of the key counter
unit.
10. Reassemble the machine.
117
2. Installation
Anti-Condensation Heater
Installation Procedure
118
Anti-Condensation Heater
Position the white marker [B] at the rear-left corner when you reattach the ARDF exposure glass.
119
2. Installation
Position the marker at the front-left corner when you reattach the exposure glass.
9. Move the scanner carriage fully across to the right side by rotating the scanner motor [A] at the rear
of the machine.
10. Put the connector of the heater [B] through the cutout [C].
11. Move the scanner carriage to the left side as shown above by rotating the scanner motor at the rear
of the machine.
12. Install the heater in the scanner unit ( x 1).
13. Secure the cable cover [A] and the left side of the heater ( x 1).
120
Anti-Condensation Heater
121
2. Installation
Tray Heater
Installation Procedure
2 Mainframe
122
Tray Heater
1. Remove the rear connector cover [A] (rivet screw x 1) of the mainframe.
2. Disconnect the harness [B].
123
2. Installation
5. Remove the securing brackets [A] ( x 1 each), and then the rear cover [B] of the paper feed unit
( x 2).
8. Connect the heater harness [A] of the heater to the relay harness [B].
124
Tray Heater
9. Insert the heater harness [A] into the tube [B], and push the tube against the rear frame of the paper
feed unit as shown above.
Make sure that the tube is in contact with the rear frame [C].
Make sure that the connector [A] is placed securely as shown above.
Make sure that the edge of the tube [B] is placed as shown above.
11. Reattach the rear cover of the paper feed unit ( x 2) and securing brackets ( x 1 each)
125
2. Installation
12. Remove the connector cap [A] from the tray heater harness.
13. Connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness [C] of the mainframe.
Do not connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness of the mainframe before installing
the securing bracket [D]. Otherwise, the securing bracket may pinch the relay harness.
126
Tray Heater
1. Remove the rear connector cover [A] (rivet screw x 1) of the mainframe.
2. Disconnect the harness [B].
127
2. Installation
5. Remove the securing brackets [A] ( x 1 each), and then rear cover [B] of the paper feed unit (
x 2).
8. Connect heater harness [A] of the heater to the relay harness [B].
128
Tray Heater
9. Remove the harness guide [A] ( x 1), and move it in the blue arrow direction as shown above.
10. Insert the heater harness [A] into the tube [B], and push the tube against the rear frame of the paper
feed unit as shown above.
Make sure that the tube is contact with the rear frame [C].
129
2. Installation
Make sure that the edge of the tube [A] is placed as shown above.
The clamp [B] is not used.
12. Reinstall the harness guide.
13. Reattach the rear cover of the paper feed unit ( x 2) and securing brackets ( x 1 each).
2
14. Remove the connector cap [A] from the tray heater harness.
15. Connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness [C] of the mainframe.
Do not connect the relay harness [B] to the tray heater harness of the mainframe before installing
the securing bracket [D]. Otherwise, the securing bracket may pinch the relay harness.
130
Controller Options
Controller Options
Overview
This machine has I/F card slots for optional I/F connections and SD card slot applications.
After you install an option, check that the machine can recognize it (see "Check All Connections" at the 2
end of this section).
SD Card Slots
Slot 1 is used for Security Card by default. Merge multiple SD cars in one SD card If the following
optional applications are to be installed in this machine; PostScript 3, PictBridge and/or IPDS.
Slot 2 is used for VM card (App2Me) by default or for service only (for example, updating the
firmware). If the Browser Unit is to be installed in this machine, remove the VM card from the SD slot
2, and then use the SD slot 2 for installing the Browser Unit. Reinstall the VM card in the SD slot 2
after completing the installation of the Browser Unit.
131
2. Installation
USB Slots
Left-side USB slot [C]: Used for connecting a digital camera (only works if PictBridge is installed).
Right-side USB slot [D]: Used when installing the optional USB2.0/SD card slot
Overview
The service program "SD Card Appli Move" (SP5-873) lets you copy application programs from one SD
card to another SD card.
Slot 1 is used to store application programs. But there are four possible applications (PostScript 3, Security
Card (DataOverwriteSecurity and HDD Encryption Unit), PictBridge, IPDS). You cannot run application
programs from Slot 2. However you can move application programs from Slot 2 to Slot 1 with the following
procedure.
Make sure that the target SD card has enough space.
1. Enter SP5873 "SD Card Appli Move".
2. Then move the application from the SD Card in Slot 2 to the SD Card in Slot 1.
132
Controller Options
SD Card Storage:
1. Hold down the ITB lock lever [A] and turn it in the arrow direction.
2. Remove the inner cover [B] ( x 4), and then keep the SD card in the place [C] after you
copy the application program from one card to another card.
You cannot copy PostScript application to another SD card. You have to copy the other application
(PictBridge, Security Card or IPDS) to the SD card that stores the PostScript application.
Move Exec
The menu "Move Exec" (SP5-873-001) lets you copy application programs from the original SD card to
another SD card.
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on the machine.
If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware
upgrade or application merge.
1. Turn the main switch off.
2. Make sure that an SD card is in SD Card Slot 1. The application program is copied to this SD card.
3. Insert the SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 2.The application program is copied
from this SD card.
4. Turn the main switch on.
5. Start the SP mode.
6. Select SP5-873-001 "Move Exec."
7. Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8. Turn the main switch off.
9. Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.
133
2. Installation
Undo Exec
"Undo Exec" (SP5-873-002) lets you copy back application programs from an SD card to the original SD
2 card. You can use this program when, for example, you have mistakenly copied some programs by using
Move Exec (SP5-873-001).
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on the machine.
If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware
upgrade or application merge.
1. Turn the main switch off.
2. Insert the original SD card in SD Card Slot 2. The application program is copied back into this card.
3. Insert the SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 1.The application program is copied
back from this SD card.
4. Turn the main switch on.
5. Start the SP mode.
6. Select SP5-873-002 "Undo Exec."
7. Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8. Turn the main switch off.
9. Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.
This step assumes that the application programs in the SD card are used by the machine.
10. Turn the main switch on.
11. Check that the application programs run normally.
12. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see "Check All Connections" at the end of this
section).
PostScript 3
The PostScript3 application and fonts cannot be moved to another SD card. However, other
applications can be moved onto the PostScript3 SD card.
134
Controller Options
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
1. Remove the SD slot cover [A] from the SD card slots ( x 1).
2. Remove the Security Card [B] from the SD slot 1 and VM card [C] from the SD slot 2.
3. Turn the SD-card label face of the Security Card [A] to the front of the machine. Then push it [A] slowly
into SD slot 2 [B] until you hear a click.
4. Turn the SD-card label face of the PostScript3 [B] to the front of the machine. Then push it slowly into
slot 1 [B] until you hear a click.
5. Plug in and turn on the main power switch, and then execute "Move Exec" with SP5-873-001.
For details, see "SD Card Appli Move".
6. Turn off the machine after completing the "Move Exec".
7. Remove the Security Card from the SD slot 2, and then keep the Security Card in the place for the SD
card storage ( p.132 "SD Card Appli Move").
8. Reinstall the VM card in the SD slot 2.
9. Attach the SD slot cover ( x 1).
135
2. Installation
10. Attach the "Adobe PostScript 3" decal [A] to the front door.
11. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see "Check All Connections" at the end of this
section).
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
136
Controller Options
IEEE1284
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, g (Wireless LAN),
IEEE1284, Bluetooth).
137
2. Installation
Installation Procedure
2 Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at one time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, g (Wireless
LAN), IEEE1284, Bluetooth).
138
Controller Options
4. Peel off the double-sided tapes on the Velcro fasteners [A], and then attach them at the front left and
rear left of the machine.
5. Attach "ANT1" (having a black ferrite core) [B] to the front left of the machine.
6. Attach "ANT2" (having a white ferrite core) [C] to the rear right of the machine.
Make sure that the cables are not slack. Keep them wired tightly along the covers.
You may have to move the machine if the reception is not clear.
Make sure that the machine is not located near an appliance or any type of equipment that generates
strong magnetic fields.
Put the machine as close as possible to the access point.
139
2. Installation
The Network I/F (default: Ethernet) must be set for either Ethernet or wireless LAN.
3. Select "Interface Settings".
4. Press "Wireless LAN". Only the wireless LAN options show.
5. Communication Mode. Select either "802.11 Ad hoc", "Ad hoc" or "Infrastructure".
6. SSID Setting. Enter the SSID setting. (The setting is case sensitive.)
7. Channel. You need this setting when Ad Hoc Mode is selected.
Range: 1 to 14 (default: 11)
The allowed range for the channel settings may vary for different countries.
8. WEP (Encryption) Setting. The WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) setting is designed to protect wireless
data transmission. The same WEP key is required on the receiving side in order to unlock encoded
data. There are 64 bit and 128 bit WEP keys.
WEP:
Selects "Active" or "Inactive" ("Inactive" is default.).
140
Controller Options
SP Mode and UP Mode Settings for IEEE 802.11 a/g, g Wireless LAN
The following SP commands and UP modes can be set for IEEE 802.11 a/g, g.
5840-006 Channel MAX Sets the maximum range of the channel settings for the country.
Sets the minimum range of the channels settings allowed for your
5840-007 Channel MIN
country.
5840-011 WEP Key Select Used to select the WEP key (Default: 00).
141
2. Installation
Used to show the maximum length of the string that can be used
WEP Mode
for the WEP Key entry.
2
Bluetooth
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, g (Wireless LAN),
IEEE1284, Bluetooth).
142
Controller Options
3. Insert the Bluetooth card [B] into the Bluetooth card adaptor.
4. Install the Bluetooth card adaptor on the Bluetooth board.
5. Attach the antenna cap to the Bluetooth board.
6. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see "Check All Connections" at the end of this
section).
2
PictBridge
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You must install the PictBridge option in SD Card slot 1. However, the Postscript3 option, Security
Card and IPDS unit option are also installed in SD Card slot 1. You must do the SD Card Appli move
procedure first if you have the PpostScript3, Security Card or IPDS unit option installed and you want
to install the PictBridge unit.
143
2. Installation
3. Turn the SD card label face of the PictBridge [A] to the front of the machine. Then push it slowly into
SD slot 2 until you hear a click.
4. Plug in and turn on the main power switch, and then execute "Move Exec" with SP5-873-001.
For details, see "SD Card Appli Move".
5. Turn off the machine after completing the "Move Exec".
6. Remove the PictBrdige from the SD slot 2, and then keep the PictBrdige card in the place for the SD
card storage ( p.132 "SD Card Appli Move").
7. Reinstall the VM card in the SD slot 2.
8. Attach the SD slot cover ( x 1).
9. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see "Check All Connections" at the end of this
section).
Installation Procedure
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
144
Controller Options
3. Turn the SD-card label face of the Browser Unit [A] to the front of the machine. Then push it slowly
into SD slot 2 [A] until you hear a click.
4. Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
5. Push the "User Tools" key.
If an administrator setting is registered for the machine, step 5 and 6 are required. Otherwise,
skip to step 7
6. Push the "Login/ Logout" key.
7. Login with the administrator user name and password.
8. Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.
9. Touch "Install" on the LCD.
10. Touch "SD Card".
11. Touch the "Browser" line.
145
2. Installation
12. Under "Install to" touch "Machine HDD" and touch "Next".
13. When you see "Ready to Install", check the information on the screen to confirm your previous
selection.
14. Touch "OK". You will see "Installing the extended feature... Please wait.", and then "Completed".
15. Touch "Exit" to go back to the setting screen.
Gigabit Ethernet
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
146
Controller Options
147
2. Installation
4. Install the Gigabit Ethernet board [A] in the connector [B] on the controller board.
7. Attach the ferrite core [A] to the LAN cable [B] as shown above, and connect the LAN cable to the
machine.
8. Make sure that the machine can recognize this option (see "Check All Connections" at the end of this
section).
148
3. Preventive Maintenance
Maintenance Tables
See "Appendices" for the following information:
Preventive Maintenance Items
Other Yield Parts
149
3. Preventive Maintenance
PM Parts Settings
Before Removing the Old PM Parts
Item SP
Black: 3902-001
Cyan: 3902-002
Development Unit
Magenta: 3902-003
Yellow: 3902-004
Black: 3902-009
Cyan: 3902-010
Drum Unit
Magenta: 3902-011
Yellow: 3902-012
*1: Only if the toner collection bottle is replaced before the machine detects near-full.
For the following units, there is a new unit detection mechanism. It is not necessary to reset PM counters.
Development unit
150
PM Parts Settings
Operation Check
151
3. Preventive Maintenance
152
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Beforehand
153
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Special Tools
Part Number Description Qty
154
Image Adjustment
Image Adjustment
Scanning
Check the printing registration/side-to-side adjustment and the blank margin adjustment before you do
the following scanner adjustments.
A: Sub-scan magnification
1. Put the test chart on the exposure glass. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2. Check the magnification ratio. Adjust with SP4-008 if necessary.
Standard: 1.0%.
155
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4
A: Leading Edge Registration
1. Put the test chart on the exposure glass. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2. Check the leading edge and side-to-side registration. Adjust the following SP modes if necessary.
Standard: 0 2 mm for the leading edge registration, 0 2 mm for the side-to-side registration.
SP mode
ARDF
156
Image Adjustment
157
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Registration
Image Area
Leading Edge
Adjusts the leading edge registration for each paper type and process line speed.
Side to Side
Adjusts the side-to-side registration for each paper feed station. Use SP mode (SP1-002) to adjust the side-
to-side registration for the optional paper feed unit, LCT, and duplex unit.
Adjustment Standard
Leading edge (sub-scan direction): 4.2 1.5 mm
Side to side (main-scan direction): 2.25 1.75 mm
158
Image Adjustment
Adjustment Procedure
1. Enter SP2-109-003.
2. Print out the test pattern (14: Trimming Area) with SP2-109-003.
Registration can change slightly as shown on the previous page. Print some pages of the
"Trimming Area" for step 3 and 4. Then average the leading edge and side-to-side registration
values, and adjust each SP mode.
3. Do the leading edge registration adjustment.
1) Check the leading edge registration and adjust it with SP1-001.
2) Select the adjustment conditions (paper type and process line speed).
3) Input the value. Then press the key.
4
4) Generate a trim pattern to check the leading edge adjustment.
4. Do the side-to-side registration adjustment.
1) Check the side-to-side registration and adjust it with SP1-002.
2) Select the adjustment conditions (paper feed station).
3) Input the value. Then press the key.
4) Generate a trim pattern to check the leading edge adjustment.
Adjust the erase margin C and D only if the registration (main scan and sub scan) cannot be adjusted
within the standard values. Do the registration adjustment after adjusting the erase margin C and D,
and then adjust the erase margin A and B.
159
4. Replacement and Adjustment
1. Enter SP2-109-003.
2. Print out the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern) with SP2-109-003.
3. Check the erase margin A and B. Adjust them with SP2-103-001 to -010 if necessary.
Leading edge: 1.5 to 5.0 mm,
Side-to-side: 0.5 to 4.0 mm,
Trailing edge: 0.5 to 0.6 mm
Color Registration
160
Image Adjustment
1. After you transport or move the machine (you should do the forced line position adjustment if
you install the machine at the user location.) if the machine is pre-installed at the workshop and
moved to the user location,
2. When you remove the PCDU
3. When you remove or replace the image transfer belt, image transfer belt unit or laser optical
housing unit
The ACC is usually sufficient to adjust the color balance to get the best print output. You only need
the printer gamma correction to fine-tune to meet user requirements.
4
Use SP modes if you want to modify the printer gamma curve created with ACC. You can adjust the gamma
data for the following:
Highlight
Middle
Shadow areas
IDmax.
The adjustable range is from 0 to 30 (31 steps).
Copy Mode
- Photo Mode -
161
4. Replacement and Adjustment
162
Image Adjustment
Text parts of the test pattern cannot be printed clearly after you adjust "shadow" as shown above. At
this time, check if the 5 line/mm pattern at each corner is printed clearly. If it is not, adjust the offset
value of "shadow" again until it is.
163
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Printer Mode
There are six adjustable modes (select these modes with printer SP1-102-001):
1200 x 1200 photo mode
1200 x 1200 text mode
2400 x 600 photo mode
2400 x 600 text mode
1800 x 600 photo mode
1800 x 600 text mode
600 x 600 photo mode
K C M Y
- Adjustment Procedure -
1. Do ACC for the printer mode.
2. Turn the main power off and on.
3. Enter SP mode.
4. Select "Printer SP".
5. Select SP1-102-001. Then select the necessary print mode to adjust.
6. Choose SP1-103-1 to print out a tone control test sheet if you want to examine the image quality for
these settings.
7. Adjust the color density with SP1-104. Compare the tone control test sheet with the C4 test chart.
Adjust the density in this order: "ID Max", "Shadow", "Middle", "Highlight".
8. Use SP1-105-001 to keep the adjusted settings.
164
Exterior Covers
Exterior Covers
PCDU Toner Collection Bottle
If you replace this toner collection bottle after the machine detects that it is full or near-full, the machine
automatically resets the PM counter for the PCDU toner collection bottle after replacement.
But, if you replace a bottle that is not full or near-full, then you must reset the PM counter for this unit. To do
this, set SP 3902 019 to 1 before you start to work on the machine.
Front Door
165
4. Replacement and Adjustment
166
Exterior Covers
2. Release the tab [A], and then remove the ITB cleaning unit cover [B]. 4
Left Cover
167
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Rear Cover
168
Exterior Covers
Dust Filter
4
1. Dust filter cover [A] (hooks)
2. Dust filter [B]
169
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Operation Panel
4
1. Remove six screws on the operation panel [A].
2. Slide the operation panel to the front side.
170
Exterior Covers
Do not use items [2] to [9] on the Self-Diagnostic Menu. These items are for design use only.
1. Press , press "1", "1", "9", "3", and then press 5 times to open the Self-Diagnostics menu.
171
4. Replacement and Adjustment
2. Press the ITB lock lever [A] and turn it up clockwise as shown above.
3. Inner right cover [B] ( x 2)
Inner Cover
4. Remove the front right cover [A] with the operation panel [B] lifted up ( x 1).
172
Exterior Covers
4
1. Right upper cover [A] ( x 2)
173
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4
1. Inverter tray [A]
2. Paper exit cover [B] ( x 1)
Inverter Tray
174
Exterior Covers
Inner Tray
4
1. Inner tray [A] ( x 2)
1. Left frame cover ( p.173 "Left Frame and Left Frame Rear Cover")
2. Paper exit cover ( p.174)
3. Inner tray ( p.175)
175
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Scanner Unit
Exposure Glass
176
Scanner Unit
Position the white marker [B] at the rear-left corner when you reattach the ARDF exposure glass.
177
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Position the marker at the front-left corner when you reattach the exposure glass.
The three screws [B] do not need to be fully removed. Just loosen them to remove the SBU cover.
178
Scanner Unit
Exposure Lamp
179
4. Replacement and Adjustment
180
Scanner Unit
10. Release the cable clamp [A] (one hook under the cable clamp) at the rear edge of the exposure lamp. 4
11. Hold down the snap [B], and then slide the exposure lamp [C] to the front side.
Reassembling
181
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Run the cable so there is no slack. Slide the adjustor clamp [A] to adjust the cable slack.
[B]: Good
[C]: Not good
Scanner Motor
Make sure that the ground plate [B] is attached when installing the scanner motor in the scanner
motor bracket.
Do the scanner image adjustment after replacing the scanner motor ( p.155 "Image
Adjustment").
182
Scanner Unit
When reassembling
Adjust the following SP modes after you replace the sensor board unit:
SP4008 (Sub Scan Mag.Adjustment): See "Image Adjustment: Scanning" (p.155 "Image
Adjustment").
SP4010 (LE Regist Adjust): See "Image Adjustment: Scanning" (p.155 "Image Adjustment").
SP4011 (S-to-S Regist Adjustment): See "Image Adjustment: Scanning" (p.155 "Image
Adjustment").
183
4. Replacement and Adjustment
SP4688 (DF: Density Adjustment): Use this to adjust the density level if the ID of outputs made in the
DF and Platen mode is different.
Scanner HP Sensor
3. Move the 1st scanner carriage [A] to the right side by rotating the scanner motor [B] clockwise.
184
Scanner Unit
185
4. Replacement and Adjustment
186
Scanner Unit
187
4. Replacement and Adjustment
188
Scanner Unit
1. Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder.
2. Pass the right end (with the ball) [B] through the square hole. Pass the left end (with the ring) through
the notch.
3. Wind the right end counterclockwise (shown from the machines front) five times. Wind the left end
clockwise three times.
The two green marks [C] come together when you have done this. Stick the wire to the pulley
with tape. This lets you easily handle the assembly at the time of installation.
Do not attach the pulley to the shaft with the screw at this time.
5. Insert the left end into the slit [B]. The end should go via the rear track of the left pulley [C] and the
rear track of the movable pulley [D].
189
4. Replacement and Adjustment
6. Hook the right end onto the front scanner wire bracket [A]. The end should go via the rear track of
the right pulley [B] and the rear track of the movable pulley [C].
Do not attach the scanner wire bracket with the screw at this time.
190
Scanner Unit
8. Insert a scanner positioning pin [A] through the 2nd carriage hole [B] and the left holes [C] in the front
rail. Insert another scanner positioning pin [D] through the 1st carriage hole [E] and the right holes in
the front rail [F].
9. Insert two more scanner positioning pins through the holes in the rear rail.
10. Screw the drive pulley to the shaft [G].
11. Screw the scanner wire bracket to the front rail [H].
12. Install the scanner wire clamp [I].
13. Pull out the positioning pins.
Make sure the 1st and 2nd carriages move smoothly after you remove the positioning pins. Do
steps 8 through 13 again if they do not. 4
Rear Scanner Wire
191
4. Replacement and Adjustment
1. Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder.
2. Pass the left end (with the ball) [B] through the drive pulley notch. Pass the right end (with the ring)
through the drive pulley hole.
3. Wind the left end [B] clockwise (shown from the machines front) five times. Wind the right end
counterclockwise three times.
The two green marks [C] come together when you do this. Attach the wire to the pulley with tape.
This lets you easily handle the assembly at the time of installation.
4. Install the drive pulley on the shaft.
Do not attach the pulley on the shaft with the screw at this time.
5. Install the wire.
The winding of the wire on the three pulleys at the rear of the scanner should be the same as the
winding on the three pulleys at the front. This must show as a mirror image.
Example: At the front of the machine, the side of the drive pulley with the three windings must face the
front of the machine. At the rear of the machine, it must face the rear.
6. Do steps 7 through 13 from the "Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire" (p.185 "Front Scanner Wire").
192
Scanner Unit
4
When removing the rear scanner wire, removing the timing pulley [A] is required before moving
the shaft ( x 1).
193
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Laser Optics
Turn off the main switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section.
Laser beams can cause serious eye injury.
Be sure to turn off the main switch and disconnect the power plug from the power outlet before
beginning any disassembly or adjustment of the laser unit. This copier uses a class IIIb laser beam
with a wavelength of 648 - 663 nm and an output of 9 mW. The laser can cause serious eye injury.
Laser Unit
Before installing a new laser unit, remove the polygon motor holder bracket and the tag from the new
unit.
194
Laser Optics
4
1. Polygon mirror motor cover [A] of the laser unit ( x 4)
195
4. Replacement and Adjustment
3. Install the three screws [C] (removed in step 2) in the laser unit.
4. Reinstall the polygon mirror motor cover [A] ( x 4).
4 4. Execute SP2-220-002 to clear the Mirror-No.2 positioning motor setting for Magenta.
5. Execute SP2-220-003 to clear the Mirror-No.2 positioning motor setting for Yellow.
6. Exit the SP mode.
7. Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord of the copier.
196
Laser Optics
197
4. Replacement and Adjustment
If this step is not correctly done, an image problem may occur on printouts.
198
Laser Optics
The printed values [A] are different for each laser unit.
5. Print the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern in the SP2-109-003).
6. Check that the left and right trim margin is within 4 1 mm. If not, change the standard value for the
main scan magnification adjustment.
7. Select "0" with SP2-109-003 after printing the "1-dot trimming pattern.
8. Do the line position adjustment.
First do SP2-111-003.
Then do SP2-111-001.
To check if SP 2-111-001 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is
displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-010 to -012.
9. Exit the SP mode.
199
4. Replacement and Adjustment
200
Image Creation
Image Creation
PCDU (Photo Conductor and Development Unit)
Do not touch the OPC drum. Do not let metal objects touch the development sleeve.
1. Open the front door.
2. PCDU toner collection bottle ( p.165)
3. Hold down the ITB lock lever [A] and turn it in the arrow direction.
4. PCDU [B] ( x 2 each)
201
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Remove the cover [A] on the toner inlet and pull out the tape [B] from the new development unit before
installing a new PCDU in the machine.
The new drum unit has a front cover. When you attach the new drum unit to the development unit, remove
the front cover first.
Use it for installing the new drum unit and development unit.
1. If you install a new drum unit only, set SP 3902-xxx to "1".
Black: 3902-009
Cyan: 3902-010
Magenta: 3902-011
Yellow: 3902-012
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the drum unit automatically, after
you turn the power on again.
2. If you install a new development unit only, set SP 3902-xxx to "1".
Black: 3902-001
Cyan: 3902-002
Magenta: 3902-003
Yellow: 3902-004
202
Image Creation
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the development unit automatically,
after you turn the power on again.
3. Turn the machine power off.
4. PCDU ( p.201)
203
4. Replacement and Adjustment
When the development unit is removed from the drum unit, clean the entrance mylar [A] with a
vacuum cleaner.
204
Image Creation
Remove the corresponding color PCDU. For example, if you remove the toner hopper unit: K,
remove the black PCDU.
205
4. Replacement and Adjustment
206
Image Creation
Do not try to open the toner hopper shutter fully at one try. This shutter comes off easily without
the inner cover. If the toner hopper shutter has come off, reattach it.
2. Pour the developer (8 g) into the inlet [B] of the toner hopper unit.
3. Close the toner hopper shutter.
4. Reassemble the machine.
207
4. Replacement and Adjustment
NOTE
208
Image Creation
When removing the toner supply gear unit for Yellow, one of screws on the toner supply gear unit
is difficult to see.
1) Remove the left cover ( p.167).
4
2) Check the screw position [A] as shown above.
8. Release the clamp [A], and then disconnect the harness [B].
209
4. Replacement and Adjustment
NOTE
Apply Silicon Grease G501 to the gear of the motor. The appropriate amount of grease is as
shown below.
4
The flat screwdriver in the photo is a small size.
210
Image Creation
7. Gears [A] ( x 1)
211
4. Replacement and Adjustment
NOTE
Apply Silicon Grease G501 to the gear of the motor. The appropriate amount of grease is as
shown below.
212
Image Creation
213
4. Replacement and Adjustment
214
Image Transfer
Image Transfer
ITB Cleaning Unit
If you replace the cleaning unit or toner collection bottle after the machine detects that it is full or near-full,
the machine automatically resets the PM counter for the bottle after replacement.
But, if you replace a bottle that is not full or near-full, then you must reset the PM counter for this unit. To do
this, set SPs 3902-017 and -020 to 1 before you turn off the power switch.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the units automatically, after you turn the power
on again.
SP 3902-017 is for the ITB cleaning unit and SP 3902-020 is for the ITB toner collection bottle. 4
215
4. Replacement and Adjustment
216
Image Transfer
8. Grasp the handles [A], and then pull out the ITB unit fully [B] ( x 2, x 1).
9. Remove the ITB unit motor after pulling out the ITB unit from the machine. ( "Next procedure")
If it takes much time to reinstall the ITB unit after removing it from the machine, close the paper transfer
unit to prevent the drum units from being exposed to light.
217
4. Replacement and Adjustment
218
Image Transfer
5. Front holder bracket [A] (as seen from the front) ( x 1: M3x10) 4
6. Rear holder bracket [A] (as seen from the rear) ( x 1: M3x10)
219
4. Replacement and Adjustment
220
Image Transfer
12. Attach the handle [A], which was removed in step 7, to the projection [B] on the rear left side ( x 4
1).
221
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4 There is a rim [A] at each edge of the transfer belt. The ends of all the rollers ([B] for example) in the
transfer belt unit must be between the two rims.
There are two rims (width [C]: about 5 mm) at the front and rear edges inside the image transfer
belt.
This belt must be installed the correct way around. When you reinstall the image transfer belt unit,
install it with the white mark [A] on the belt at the rear side of the unit.
222
Image Transfer
5. Disconnect two harnesses [A], and then remove the ITB contact motor unit ( x 1)
6. Gears [A] ( x 1)
7. ITB contact motor [B] ( x 2)
223
4. Replacement and Adjustment
NOTE
Apply Silicon Grease G501 to the gear of the motor. The appropriate amount of grease is as
shown below.
224
Paper Transfer
Paper Transfer
PTR (Paper Transfer Roller) Unit
If you install a new PTR unit, then set SP 3902-018 to "1" before you start this procedure.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the paper transfer unit automatically,
after you turn the power on again.
1. Open the duplex unit.
If the paper transfer unit cannot be opened, keep your hand supporting the PTR unit as shown
above and release very carefully the front tension lever [A] of the PTR unit. In this case, the PTR
unit open lever [B] does not work to open the PTR unit.
225
4. Replacement and Adjustment
The spring tension of the tension lever is very strong. Be very careful to release the tension lever.
Otherwise, your hand or fingers may be injured.
3. Remove the PTR unit [A], releasing the two locks [B].
226
Paper Transfer
4
2. Release the arm [A] ( x 1).
3. Open the paper transfer unit [B] fully.
ID Sensor Board
227
4. Replacement and Adjustment
If the black spacer [B] is stuck to the sensor board as shown above, remove all black spacers.
These black spacers should be used when a new ID sensor board is installed.
228
Paper Transfer
Do not use a dry cloth. Otherwise, the ID sensors may get more dirty due to static electricity.
3. Input all correction coefficients [A] for the ID sensor with the SP modes referring to the barcode sheet
provided with the new ID sensor unit/board.
229
4. Replacement and Adjustment
7. Spring [A]
Do not forget to reinstall the spring [A] when reassembling. Otherwise, SC400 may occur.
8. PTR contact motor bracket [B] ( x 3)
230
Paper Transfer
NOTE
Apply Silicon Grease G501 to the gear of the motor. The appropriate amount of grease is as
shown below.
231
4. Replacement and Adjustment
232
Drive Unit
Drive Unit
There are some motors and clutches that are not shown in the above drawing:
Gear Unit
233
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4. Remove all connectors and clamps (blue arrows) on the HVPS: CB board [A].
5. Pull all the PCDUs to the front side. ( p.201)
234
Drive Unit
Registration Motor
The picture below shows how to remove the screw [C] of the gear unit. The controller box should
be closed at this time.
235
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4
Paper Feed Motor: T1
The picture below shows how to remove the screw [B] of the paper feed motor T1.
236
Drive Unit
4
Paper Feed Motor: T2
Do not remove the PCDUs when you replace the drum motor-CMY.
1. Rear cover ( p.168)
2. Rear lower cover ( p.168)
3. Open the controller box ( p.294 "Controller Box")
237
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Drum/Development Motor: K
238
Drive Unit
239
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4
4. Loosen the stay [A] ( x 1, hook [B] x 1)
The hook [B] is installed as shown above. Do not pull the stay by force, or the hook might be
broken.
The picture below shows how to remove the screw [B] of the fusing/paper exit motor.
240
Drive Unit
241
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Fusing
Fusing Unit
Turn off the main switch and wait until the fusing unit cools down before beginning any of the
procedures in this section. The fusing unit can cause serious burns.
242
Fusing
If the fusing unit is stuck to the PTR unit and cannot be removed from the machine, keep your hand supporting
the PTR unit as shown above and release very carefully the front tension lever [A] of the PTR unit. In this
case, the PTR unit open lever [B] does not work to open the PTR unit.
The spring tension of the tension lever is very strong. Be very careful to release the tension lever.
Otherwise, your hand or fingers may be injured.
Cleaning Requirement
The entrance guide plate requires cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Clean the entrance guide
plate with a cloth moistened with alcohol at the following points.
243
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Stripper Plate
244
Fusing
4. Remove the e-rings [A] at the front and rear side, and then springs [B] at the front and rear side.
245
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Cleaning Requirement
The stripper plate requires cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Clean the stripper plate with a
cloth moistened with alcohol at the following points.
246
Fusing
3. Clean the exit guide plate [A] with a cloth moistened with alcohol.
The fusing gear shafts require cleaning maintenance (if it is dirty) at every 60 K interval.
1. Fusing unit ( p.242)
2. Fusing upper cover ( p.244)
247
4. Replacement and Adjustment
5. Apply "Barrierta S552R" to the gear shafts [A] of the fusing unit. The appropriate amount of grease
is as shown above. The flat screwdriver [B] in the photo is a small size.
248
Fusing
249
4. Replacement and Adjustment
250
Fusing
7. Slide the front and rear flanges [A] to the outer sides to detach both flanges from the front and rear
heating roller brackets.
8. Hold the both flange at the front and rear side of the heating roller unit [A], and then pull the heating
roller unit [A].
251
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4
Make sure that the flange with mark F [A] is placed to the front side of the fusing unit when reinstalling
the heating roller unit.
Pressure Roller
Cleaning Procedure
The pressure roller requires cleaning maintenance (if it is dirty) at every 60 K interval.
1. Fusing unit ( p.242)
2. Fusing upper cover ( p.244 "Stripper Plate")
252
Fusing
Clean the both ends [C] of the pressure roller as well as the center area.
Replacement Procedure
1. Heating roller unit ( p.249)
253
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Apply "Barrierta S552R" to the front edge [A] and rear edge [B] of the pressure roller as shown above.
254
Fusing
Do not re-use a thermostat that is already opened. Safety is not guaranteed if you do this.
255
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Cleaning Requirement
The heating roller thermistor requires cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Clean the heating roller
thermistor with a dry cloth.
256
Fusing
257
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Cleaning Requirement
The pressure roller thermistors (center and end) require cleaning maintenance at every 60 K interval. Clean
the pressure roller thermistors (center and end) with a dry cloth.
Thermopile
258
Fusing
3. Thermopile [A] ( x 1)
Do this cleaning procedure after the fusing unit has completely cooled down. Otherwise, you may
get a serious burn.
259
4. Replacement and Adjustment
260
Fusing
261
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Paper Feed
Paper Tray
4
1. Pull paper tray 1 or 2 [A] part of the way out.
2. Remove two screws from both tray guides.
3. Pull out paper tray 1 or 2 [A].
Feed Roller
262
Paper Feed
Friction Pad
263
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Make sure that the mylar [A] does not go under the friction pad when reinstalling the friction pad.
4 Do not touch the friction pad with your bare hands, when replacing it. If you do, clean the friction pad with
a damp cloth or alcohol.
264
Paper Feed
265
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Registration Sensor
266
Paper Feed
4
4. Close the paper transfer unit [A].
5. Relay guide plate [B] ( x 2)
6. Upper vertical transport guide [C] ( x 1, x 4)
267
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Clean the registration roller and registration idle roller [A] with a damp cloth every 60 K (total count).
268
Paper Feed
269
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4. Release the rear pivot [A], and then remove the lower right door [B].
270
Paper Feed
271
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Paper Exit
Junction Gate Solenoid Fan
272
Paper Exit
273
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4
8. Paper exit unit [A]
274
Paper Exit
275
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4
Stand the paper exit unit so that [A] is facing up. Otherwise, the paper exit sensor feeler interrupts the
installation of the paper exit sensor.
Insert the hook [B] first.
Inverter Sensor
276
Paper Exit
4. Move the sensor assembly [A] to the cutout [B], and then remove it ( x1, x 1) 4
Inverter Motor
277
4. Replacement and Adjustment
278
Paper Exit
4
Make sure that harnesses are correctly set [A] along the guide on the fan frame without slack [B]. Otherwise,
the some of the wires could be pinched and damaged or cut between the fan frame and the frame of the
main machine. SC533 can be issued if the harnesses are broken.
279
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Duplex Unit
Duplex Unit
3. Move the duplex unit in the direction shown by , and remove the hook [A].
4. Disconnect the harness [B].
280
Duplex Unit
281
4. Replacement and Adjustment
282
Duplex Unit
283
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4
Duplex Entrance Motor
284
Duplex Unit
By-pass Motor
285
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Remove the clamp [B] from the bracket to disconnect the harness.
286
Duplex Unit
Use a flat-head screw driver or similar tool to push the hook [B] down.
287
4. Replacement and Adjustment
288
Duplex Unit
1. Adjust the projection [A] of the left side fence bar (it must be centered).
2. Install the by-pass paper size detection switch so that the hole [B] in this switch faces the projection
[C] of the left side fence bar.
3. Reassemble the copier.
4. Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
5. Check this switch operation with SP5803-046 (By-Pass Size Detection SW < Input Check).
289
4. Replacement and Adjustment
290
Duplex Unit
291
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Electrical Components
Boards
[A] BCU
[C] IPU
[D] DRB
[F] PSU
292
Electrical Components
293
4. Replacement and Adjustment
Controller Box
4. Remove the three screws and disconnect the scanner cable [A] (ground screw x 1)
BCU
294
Electrical Components
Make sure the NVRAM is correctly installed on the BCU. Insert the NVRAM in the NVRAM slot
with the "half-moon" pointing [B] to the downward side.
Make sure you print out the SMC reports ("SP Mode Data" and "Logging Data") before you replace
the NVRAM.
Keep NVRAM away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity can damage
NVRAM data.
295
4. Replacement and Adjustment
HDD
Copy the address book data to an SD card from the HDD with SP5846-051 before replacing the
HDD if possible.
1. Rear cover ( p.168)
2. Controller box cover ( p.293)
296
Electrical Components
2. Do SP5853-001 to copy the preset stamp data from the firmware to the HDD.
3. Do SP5846-052 to copy back the address book to the hard disk from the SD card to which you have
already copied the address book data if possible.
4. Do SP5-878-001 to install the DataOverwriteSecurity application.
5. Do SP5878-002 to install the HDD Encryption application.
6. Turn off the machine.
IPU Board
297
4. Replacement and Adjustment
298
Electrical Components
299
4. Replacement and Adjustment
DRB
SDVDB
300
Electrical Components
4
3. SDVDB [A] ( x 3, x 5)
PSU
301
4. Replacement and Adjustment
HVPS: CB Board
302
Electrical Components
4
3. HVPS: CB board [A] ( x 6, All s)
Controller Board
303
4. Replacement and Adjustment
4
5. Controller board assembly [A] ( x 7, x 2)
6. Remove the SD cards [A], interface rails [B], NVRAM [C] and RAM-DIMMs [D].
7. Controller board [E]
304
Electrical Components
Disconnecting the cables of the HDD is very important. Otherwise, the HDD is automatically
formatted and all data in the HDD is lost due to the security limitation.
4. Reassemble the machine.
5. Turn on the main power of the machine.
6. Turn off the main power of the machine, and then connect the cables of the HDD again.
4
Make sure you print out the SMC reports ("SP Mode Data" and "Logging Data") before you replace
the NVRAM.
Keep NVRAMs away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity can damage
NVRAM data.
Make sure the NVRAM is correctly installed on the controller board.
305
4. Replacement and Adjustment
306
Electrical Components
307
4. Replacement and Adjustment
8. Plug in the power cord. Then turn the main switch on.
9. SC195 occurs.
10. Copy the data from the SD card to the NVRAM ( SP5-825-001) if you have successfully copied
them to the SD card.
11. Turn the main switch off. Then remove the SD card from SD card slot 2.
12. Turn the main switch on.
13. Specify the SP and UP mode settings.
14. Do the process control self-check.
15. Do ACC for the copier application program.
16. Do ACC for the printer application program.
4
NVRAM on the Controller
1. Make sure that you have the SMC report (factory settings). This report comes with the machine (
p.49 "Initialize the Developer").
2. Output the SMC data ( SP5-990-001) if possible.
3. Turn the main switch off. Then unplug the power cord.
4. Remove the rear cover ( p.168)
Disconnecting the cables of the HDD is very important. Otherwise, the HDD is automatically
formatted and all data in the HDD is lost due to the security limitation.
7. Install a New NVRAM on the controller. Then reassemble the machine.
308
Electrical Components
309
4. Replacement and Adjustment
310
5. System Maintenance
Make sure that the data-in LED is not on before you go into the SP mode. This LED indicates that some
data is coming to the machine. When the LED is on, wait for the copier to process the data.
SP Tables
There are most commonly used SP codes in the "Main SP Tables - 1 to - 9" of "Main Chapters".
See "Appendices" for the following information:
System SP Tables (all SP codes) 5
Printer SP Tables
Scanner SP Tables
Types of SP Modes
311
5. System Maintenance
Closes all open groups and sublevels and restores the initial SP mode display.
Opens the copy window (copy mode) so you can make test copies. Press SP Mode (highlighted)
in the copy window to return to the SP mode screen,
312
Service Program Mode
Enter the SP code directly with the number keys if you know the SP number. Then press . (The
required SP Mode number will be highlighted when pressing . If not, just press the required SP
Mode number.)
Press two times to leave the SP mode and return to the copy window to resume normal operation.
Press to scroll to the previous or next display in segments the size of the screen display (page).
Press to scroll the show the previous or next line (line by line).
Press to move the highlight on the left to the previous or next selection in the list.
5
Switching Between SP Mode and Copy Mode for Test Printing
1. In the SP mode, select the test print. Then press "Copy Window".
2. Use the copy window (copier mode), to select the appropriate settings (paper size, etc.) for the test
print.
3. Press Start to start the test print.
4. Press SP Mode (highlighted) to return to the SP mode screen and repeat from step 1.
313
5. System Maintenance
314
Service Program Mode
Remarks
Paper Weight 5
Thin paper: 52-59 g/m2 (14-16lb. Bond)
Plain Paper1: 60-74 g/m2 (16-20lb. Bond)
Plain Paper2: 75-81 g/m2 (20lb. Bond)
Middle Thick: 82-105 g/m2 (20-28lb. Bond)
Thick Paper 1: 106-169 g/m2 (28lb. Bond-90lb. Index)
Thick Paper 2: 170-210 g/m2 (65lb. Cover-54lb. Bond)
Thick Paper 3: 211-256 g/m2 (65lb. Cover-54lb. Bond)
Paper Type
Paper Feed Station
N: Normal paper
P: Paper tray
MTH: Middle thick paper
B: By-pass table
TH: Thick paper
315
5. System Maintenance
Others
The following symbols are used in the SP mode tables.
FA: Factory setting
(Data may be adjusted from the default setting at the factory. Refer to the factory setting sheets enclosed.
You can find it under the jammed paper removal decal.)
DFU: Design/Factory Use only
Do not touch these SP modes in the field.
A sharp (#) to the right hand side of the mode number column means that the main switch must be turned
off and on to effect the setting change.
An asterisk (*) to the right hand side of the mode number column means that this mode is stored in the
NVRAM. If you do a RAM clear, this SP mode will be reset to the default value. "ENG" and "CTL" show
which NVRAM contains the data.
If "Alphanumeric" is written to the right of the bracket as shown above, the setting of the SP mode
shows on the screen using alphanumeric characters instead of only numbers. However, the settings
in the bracket in the SP mode table are explained by using only the numbers.
SSP: This denotes a "Special Service Program" mode setting.
316
Main SP Tables-1
Main SP Tables-1
SP1-XXX (Feed)
1001 Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the registration motor operation timing
for each mode.
Increasing a value: an image is moved to the trailing edge of paper.
Decreasing a value: an image is moved to the leading edge of paper.
317
5. System Maintenance
[Side-to-Side Registration]
Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the laser main scan start position for each
1002 mode and tray.
Increasing a value: an image is moved to the rear edge of paper.
Decreasing a value: an image is moved to the front edge of paper.
318
Main SP Tables-1
319
5. System Maintenance
Enables or disables the automatic paper size detection function of the by-pass tray.
001
This SP determines what paper size the machine detects if the detected size is less than 8.5".
0: LT SEF (default), 1: LG
1101 Specifies the settings of the reload permit for cold temperature in color mode.
Destination: NA; North America, TWN; Taiwan, EU; Europe, AA; Asia Pasific
320
Main SP Tables-1
321
5. System Maintenance
Temp.:Delta:Warm:BW:Cent
*ENG [0 to 100 / 10 / 1 deg/step]
er
020
Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) in the black and white mode
when the fusing unit is determined as warm state.
322
Main SP Tables-1
Temp.:Delta:Cold:
101 *ENG [0 to 100 / 65 / 1 deg/step]
BW2:Center
Temp.:Delta:Warm:
105
BW2:Center
*ENG [0 to 100 / 65 / 1 deg/step]
5
Temp.:Delta:Warm:
106 *ENG [0 to 100 / 80 / 1 deg/step]
BW2:End
Temp.:Delta:Warm:
107 *ENG [0 to 200 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
BW2:Press
Temp.:Delta:Hot:
109 *ENG [0 to 100 / 65 / 1 deg/step]
BW2:Center
323
5. System Maintenance
Temp.:Lower
007 *ENG [0 to 100 / 35 / 1 deg/step]
Delta:Center:Sp.1
Temp.:Upper
009 *ENG [0 to 50 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
Delta:Center:Sp.1
Temp.:Upper
015 *ENG [0 to 50 / 20 / 1 deg/step]
Delta:Center:Sp.2
Temp.:Lower
020 *ENG [0 to 100 / 25 / 1 deg/step]
Delta:Center:Sp.3
Temp.:Upper
022 *ENG [0 to 50 / 10 / 1 deg/step]
Delta:Center:Sp.3
324
Main SP Tables-1
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.
Plain1:BW:Center *ENG
[100 to 160 / NA: 140, EU/AA: 131 / 1 deg/ 5
003 step]
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
325
5. System Maintenance
326
Main SP Tables-1
Plain1:BW:Center:Low
103 *ENG [100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
Plain2:BW:Center:Low
107 *ENG [100 to 200 / 125 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
M-Thick:FC:Center:Low
113 *ENG [100 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
M-Thick:BW:Center:Low
115 *ENG [100 to 200 / 130 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
M-Thick:BW:Press:Low
116 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
Special1:FC:Center:Low
117 *ENG [100 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
327
5. System Maintenance
Special1:FC:Press:Low
118 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
Special1:BW:Center:Low
119 *ENG [100 to 200 / 130 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
Special1:BW:Press:Low
120 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
Special2:FC:Center:Low
121 *ENG [100 to 200 / 140 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
Special2:FC:Press:Low
122 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
Special2:BW:Center:Low
123 *ENG [100 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]
5 Speed
Special2:BW:Press:Low
124 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
Special3:FC:Center:Low
125 *ENG [100 to 200 / 130 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
Special3:FC:Press:Low
126 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
Special3:BW:Center:Low
127 *ENG [100 to 200 / 125 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
Special3:BW:Press:Low
128 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
328
Main SP Tables-1
329
5. System Maintenance
The heating roller has two lamps. One heats the center of the heating roller and the other
heats both ends of the heating roller.
330
Main SP Tables-1
These SPs are used for the fusing temperature control for variable job images. This control
saves the power comsumption when the machine copies or prints a job text image in black
and white mode.
331
5. System Maintenance
003-
[Envir. Correct:Fusing]
006
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
Execute Pattern *ENG
001 0: Off, 1: On
Humidity:Threshold:M-
*ENG [0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]
002 humid
Specifies the threshold between low and middle humidity.
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:M-
*ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
004 humid
Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in middle humidity.
332
Main SP Tables-1
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:H-
*ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
005 humid
Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in high humidity.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
Control Method Switch *ENG
0: Fixed Duty, 1: Power Control
001
Selects the heater control method.
Use "1: Power Contro" if hot offset occurs after power-on and input voltage is relatively hight.
333
5. System Maintenance
5 108
Displays the temperature at the end of the pressure roller when an SC was issued.
334
Main SP Tables-1
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
SC Display *ENG
001 0: ON, 1: OFF
Sepcifies the threshold temperature 1 for the warming up in the low temperature condition.
Time:Heat Storage
010 * ENG [0 to 250 / 60 / 1 sec./step]
Devision1
Sepcifies the execution time 1 for the warming up in the low temperature condition.
Time:Heat Storage
011 * ENG [0 to 250 / 30 / 1 sec../step]
Devision2
Sepcifies the execution time 2 for the warming up in the low temperature condition.
335
5. System Maintenance
336
Main SP Tables-1
These SPs can adjust the sub-scan magnification error. However, first read the "Sub-scan
1803 Magnification Error" in the "Troubleshooting Guide" (Main Chapters) to execute these SPs.
NEVER EXECUTE these SPs before reading the "Sub-scan Magnification Error". Otherwise,
color registration errors occur on outputs and this cannot be recovered by the line position
adjustment.
337
5. System Maintenance
Main SP Tables-2
SP2-XXX (Drum)
338
Main SP Tables-2
These values are the parameters for the automatic line position adjustment and are adjusted
2101 at the factory. However, you must input a value for SP2101-001 after replacing the laser
optics housing unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and
Adjustment" section. The value should be provided with the new laser optics housing unit.
[Magnification Adjust]
2102 These values are the parameters for the automatic line position adjustment and are adjusted
at the factory. These SPs must be input only when a new laser unit is installed.
339
5. System Maintenance
001 Bk *ENG
002 C *ENG
[80 to 120 / 100 / 1 %/step]
003 M *ENG
004 Y *ENG
[Test Pattern]
2109
Generates the test pattern using "COPY Window" tab in the LCD.
340
Main SP Tables-2
0 None
1: Vertical Line (1dot) 12. Independent Pattern (2dot)
2: Vertical Line (2dot) 13. Independent Pattern (4dot)
3: Horizontal (1dot) 14. Trimming Area
4: Horizontal (2dot) 16: Hounds Tooth Check (Horizontal)
003 5: Grid Vertical Line 17: Band (Horizontal)
6: Grid Horizontal Line 18: Band (Vertical)
7: Grid pattern Small 19: Checker Flag Pattern
8: Grid pattern Large 20: Grayscale Vertical Margin
9: Argyle Pattern Small 21: Grayscale Horizontal Margin
10: Argyle Pattern Large 23: Full Dot Pattern 5
11. Independent Pattern (1dot)
006 Density: Bk -
Specifies the color density for the test pattern.
007 Density: C - [0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
341
5. System Maintenance
[Skew Adjustment]
001 Execute: C *ENG Changes the current skew adjustment values to the
values specified with SP2117.
002 Execute: M *ENG
These SPs must be used when a new laser optics
housing unit is installed. For details, see "Laser
003 Execute: Y *ENG Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and
Adjustment" section.
001 C *ENG
003 Y *ENG
342
Main SP Tables-2
[P-Sensor Test]
[TM-Sensor Test]
[P-Sensor Test] 5
2141 Displays the maximum result values of the ID sensor check.
Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment and the process
control
[TM-Sensor Test]
[P-Sensor Test]
343
5. System Maintenance
[TM-Sensor Test]
[P-Sensor Test]
[TM-Sensor Test]
[P-Sensor Test]
[TM-Sensor Test]
344
Main SP Tables-2
[P-Sensor Test]
[TM-Sensor Test]
2193
[MUSIC Condition] 5
Line Position Adjustment: Condition Setting
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
007 Execution Result *ENG
0: Completed successfully, 1: Failed
345
5. System Maintenance
2220 Resets the value of the skew adjustment motor for each color.
5 These SPs must be executed when a new laser optics housing unit is installed. For details,
see "Laser Unit" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section.
[Ambient Temp/Hum:Display]
2241
Displays the environment temperature and humidity.
346
Main SP Tables-2
003
Image Transfer:Low Speed *ENG [0 to 60 / 13 / 1 A]
5
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for thick 1 paper.
347
5. System Maintenance
2403 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
2407 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in full color mode.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
[Plain-T:SizeCorrect:BW]
2411 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
348
Main SP Tables-2
002 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S1 *ENG [100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1 *ENG S1 size > 290 mm (Paper width)
349
5. System Maintenance
[Plain-T:SizeCorrect:FC]
2412 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
002 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S1 *ENG [100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1 *ENG S1 size > 290 mm (Paper width)
350
Main SP Tables-2
351
5. System Maintenance
2453 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
2457 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in full color mode.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
352
Main SP Tables-2
2502 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in black-and-white mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
2507
5
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in full color mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
[Thick-T:Size Correct:BW]
2511 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
353
5. System Maintenance
[Thick-T:Size Correct:FC]
5 2512 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
354
Main SP Tables-2
2553 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick2 paper in black-and-white mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
2558 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick2 paper in full color mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
5
001 Paper Transfer: 1st *ENG [0 to 200 / 13 / 1 A /step]
002 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st *ENG [1 to 50 / NA: 39, EU/AA: 26 / 1 /step]
2651 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in black-and-white mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
355
5. System Maintenance
2652 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in full color mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for middle thick in black-and-white mode.
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for middle thick in full color mode.
2753 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
356
Main SP Tables-2
2757 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in full color mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
[SP1,2,3-T:Size Correct:BW]
2761 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
002 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S1 *ENG [100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step]
357
5. System Maintenance
5 width)
358
Main SP Tables-2
[SP1,2,3-T:Size Correct:FC]
2762 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
359
5. System Maintenance
5 width)
360
Main SP Tables-2
2783 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
2787 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in full color mode.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
[SP4,5,6-T:Size Correct:BW]
5
2791 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
361
5. System Maintenance
[SP4,5,6-T:Size Correct:FC]
2792 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
2803 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
2807 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in full color mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
362
Main SP Tables-2
2833 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 5 in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
2837 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 5 in full color mode. 5
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
2852 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
2857 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in full color mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
363
5. System Maintenance
2883 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 6 in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
2887 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 6 in full color mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
If a horizontal white band at 40 mm from the leading edge occurs in the low speed mode,
002 change this setting from "-80" to "-500".
[Side Effect]:
"580 msec" is added to the first copy/ print time when using the low speed mode.
364
Main SP Tables-3
Main SP Tables-3
SP3-XXX (Process)
3012 All colors are displayed. The results are displayed in the order "Y C M K"
e.g., 11 (Y) 99 (C) 11 (M) 11 (K): The self-check for Cyan failed but the others were
successful.
See the "Error Condition Tables" in the Process Control Error section for details.
365
5. System Maintenance
005 Execution: M -
006 Execution: Y -
3014 [TD Sen Initial Set Result] Developer Initialization Result: Display
[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step ]
Display: YMCK *ENG 1: Success
2 to 9: Failure
001 Displays the developer initialization result. See the "Error Condition Tables" in the Process
Control Error section for details on the meaning of each code.
All colors are displayed. Values are displayed in the order Y M C Bk.
e.g., 1 (Y) 1 (M) 2 (C) 1 (Bk): Initialization of Cyan failed but the others succeeded.
366
Main SP Tables-3
005 Execution: M -
006 Execution: Y -
001-
DFU
005
367
5. System Maintenance
009 Upper Counter: Y *ENG Displays the total times of the Vt upper or lower
limit error.
010 Lower Counter: Bk *ENG [0 to 99 / 0 / 1 times/step]
011 Lower Counter: C *ENG
5 3021
[TD Sensor Initial Set] Developer Initialization Setting
Specifies the developer agitation time for each color at the developer initialization.
005-
Sets the execution flag of the developer initialization for each color.
008
368
Main SP Tables-3
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step ] Alphanumeric
0: FIXED (Use the fixed values for the charge DC bias
Bias Control *ENG and development DC bias set with SP2-005 and
001 SP2-229.)
1: CONTROL
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] Alphanumeric
AutoControl Prohibition
*ENG 0: Permit
003 Set
1: Forbid
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
0: Not Execute
Pre-ACC Process Control *ENG
004 1: Process Control
2: TC Control
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
0: FIXED
005 P-Pattern Selection *ENG
1: INITIALIZED
2: CALCULATED
369
5. System Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
002 NE Detection *ENG 0: ALL (Calculation and TE sensor)
1: TE Sensor
370
Main SP Tables-3
Displays the remaining amount of each color toner. These are calculated by the operating
009-012
times of the toner supply pumps.
Adjusts the threshold of toner near end for each color. The toner near end message appears
on the LCD when the remaining toner amount reaches this threshold. When one of these
013-016
SPs (SP3-101-009 to 012 or -032 to -035) reaches this threshold, toner near end is
detected.
021 This SP is the threshold for toner end. Delta Vt: Vt-Vtref
When both this SP and SP3-101-026 occur at same time, toner end is determined.
Displays the total delta Vt (Vt-Vtref) value for each color.These are calculated by pixel
022-025
counting.
028-031 Displays the consumed toner amount calculated with the pixel count for each color.
371
5. System Maintenance
032-035 Displays the remaining toner amount for each color, using pixel count.
050-053 Adjusts the threshold of the remaining toner for the toner near-end detection. DFU
372
Main SP Tables-3
001 Bk *ENG
002 C *ENG
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 time/step]
003 M *ENG
5
004 Y *ENG
[Vtcnt: Display/Set]
3221
Displays or adjusts the current Vtcnt value for each color.
005-
Displays or adjusts the Vtcnt value for each color at developer initialization.
008
373
5. System Maintenance
[Vtcnt: Display/Set]
3222
Displays or adjusts the current Vtref value for each color.
005-
Displays or adjusts the Vtref value for each color at developer initialization.
008
009-
Displays or adjusts Vtref correction by pixel coverage for each color.
012
374
Main SP Tables-3
375
5. System Maintenance
017 High Coverage: Threshold:H *ENG Adjusts the threshold of the high
coverage.
018 High Coverage: Threshold:L *ENG [0 to 100 / 20 / 1 %/step]
376
Main SP Tables-3
001 Bk *ENG
002 C *ENG
[0 to 5 / 2.7 / 0.01 V/step]
003 M *ENG
004 Y *ENG
001 Coefficient: Bk *ENG These are parameters for calculating the charge
bias referring to the development bias at process
002 Coefficient: C *ENG control.
003 Coefficient: M *ENG [-1000 to 1000 / 0 / 1 /step]
DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 + 0.001
004 Coefficient: Y *ENG x these vales) + SP3-241-005 to -008
377
5. System Maintenance
005 Offset: Bk *ENG These are additional values for calculating the
charge bias referring to the development bias at
006 Offset: C *ENG process control.
007 Offset: M *ENG [0 to 255 / 140 / 1 V/step]
DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 + 0.001
008 Offset: Y *ENG x SP3-241-001 to -004) + these values
[Coverage]
3251
These (-001 to -016) are coefficients for SP3-222-009 to -012.
002 Latest: Pixcel C *ENG Displays the latest coverage for each color.
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
005-008 "Average S" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-017.
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
009-012 "Average M" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-018.
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
013-016 "Average L" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3-251-019.
378
Main SP Tables-3
379
5. System Maintenance
005-007 Displays the ID sensor (diffusion) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments.
380
Main SP Tables-3
381
5. System Maintenance
382
Main SP Tables-3
002 Upper Limit: C *ENG Adjusts the toner supply rate during printing.
006 Minimum Supply Time: C *ENG Adjusts the minimum toner supply time.
383
5. System Maintenance
384
Main SP Tables-3
3512
[Image Adj.: Interval]
5
Adjusts the timing for execution of process control and line position adjustment during printing
or copying.
3513 Displays the last time that the PCU motors stopped.
These are used for process control execution timing.
385
5. System Maintenance
[Refresh Mode]
While making prints with low coverage, the developer is agitated with less toner consumption
3516 and the toner carrier attraction tends to increase. This may cause low image density or poor
transfer (white dots). To prevent this, the coagulated toner or overcharged toner has to be
consumed by performing the refresh mode.
386
Main SP Tables-3
387
5. System Maintenance
3517 Adjusts the threshold temperature for preventing the cleaning blade in the transfer belt
cleaning unit from being damaged. If the temperature is above this value, toner is applied
to the transfer belt at set intervals during the job to prevent the blade from flipping over.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
007 Process Control *ENG
0: OFF. 1: ON (once), 2: ON (twice)
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
008 MUSIC *ENG
0: OFF. 1: ON (once), 2: ON (twice)
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets "1", when the following values shows.
012 Vsg Average Error *ENG Vsg_reg_ave:
3.5 < Vsg_reg_ave < 4.5 or Vsg_dif_ave:
0.0 < Vsg_dif_ave < 0.5
388
Main SP Tables-3
002 Temperature: Medium *ENG Specifies the idle rotation times of the ITB
005 to
Adjusts the threshold temperature for entering the ITB idle rotation after the process control.
011
389
5. System Maintenance
[Rapi Timer]
390
Main SP Tables-3
[Vk Display]
3612
Displays Vk for each color.
001 Bk *ENG
002 C *ENG
[-300 to 300 / - / 1 V/step]
003 M *ENG
004 Y *ENG
391
5. System Maintenance
[Dev. DC Control:Display]
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 70 mm/sec
3621
Displays the development DC bias adjusted with the process control for each line speed and
color.
392
Main SP Tables-3
Displays the charge AC voltage adjusted with the process control for each color.
393
5. System Maintenance
[HST Control: C]
3712
Displays the factory settings of the magenta PCU.
394
Main SP Tables-3
[HST Control: M]
3713
Displays the factory settings of the cyan PCU.
[HST Control:Y]
3714
Displays the factory settings of the yellow PCU.
395
5. System Maintenance
001 Displays the current condition of the PCDU toner collection bottle.
Not used
002 Detection Times *CTL
[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]
Not used
003 Print Page AF Near Full *CTL
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
Not used
004 Pixel Count AF Near Full *CTL
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
Not used
Displays the pixel counter after replacement of
005 Pixel Count AF Replacement *CTL
toner collection bottle.
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
396
Main SP Tables-3
001 Displays the current condition of the ITB toner collection bottle.
Not used
002 Detection Times *CTL
[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]
Not used
003 Print Page AF Near Full *CTL
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
Not used
004 Pixel Count AF Near Full *CTL
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
397
5. System Maintenance
Not used
Displays the pixel counter after replacement of
005 Pixel Count AF Replacement *CTL
toner collection bottle.
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
012 Sets the threshold days for the near-full display. The near-full of the IT toner collection bottle
is displayed after the toner collection full sensor has detected the actuator in the ITB toner
collection bottle.
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
001 ON/OFF Setting *ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
398
Main SP Tables-3
3902 Turns the new unit detection flag for each PM unit on or off.
The use of these counters is explained in the PM section and in the relevant parts of section
3 (Replacement and Adjustment).
015 Fusing Pad *ENG Do not use 3902-013 if you only change the
cleaning unit.
016 Fusing Belt *ENG 3902-017: This is for the image transfer belt
cleaning unit.
017 ITB Cleaning Unit *ENG
399
5. System Maintenance
Main SP Tables-4
SP4-XXX (Scanner)
400
Main SP Tables-4
4013 Performs the scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off in the following mode.
Full color mode / Full Size / A3 or DLT
[Scan]
4014
Execute the scanner free fun with each mode.
401
5. System Maintenance
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 APS Min. Size *ENG 0: No Original
1: A5-Lengthwise (16K SEF if 4305 is set to 3)
5 [0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Normal Detection (the machine detects A4/LT
size as A4 or LT, depending on the paper size
4305 [8K/16K Detection] *ENG setting)
1: A4-Sideways LT-Lengthwise
2: LT-Sideways A4-Lengthwise
3: 8K 16K
001 This program enables the machine to automatically recognize the 8K/16K size.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 Detect: ON/OFF *ENG
0: ON, 1: OFF
402
Main SP Tables-4
0: Scanned image
13: Grid pattern CMYK
1: Gradation main scan A
14: Color patch CMYK
2: Gradation main scan B
15: Gray pattern (1)
3: Gradation main scan C
16: Gray pattern (2)
4: Gradation main scan D
17: Gray Pattern (3)
5: Gradation sub scan (1)
18: Shading pattern
6: Grid pattern
19: Thin line pattern
7: Slant grid pattern
20: Scanned + Grid pattern
8: Gradation RGBCMYK
21: Scanned + Gray scale
9: UCR pattern
22: Scanned + Color patch
10: Color patch 16 (1)
23: Scanned + Slant Grid C
11: Color patch 16 (2)
24: Scanned + Slant Grid D
12: Color patch 64
403
5. System Maintenance
001 Copy
003 Fax
[Saturation Adjustment]
4440
Adjusts the level of saturation for copying.
[0 to 5 / 3 / 1 /step]
0: High
1: Lowest
001 - *ENG 2: Lower
5 3: Default
4: Higher
5: Highest
404
Main SP Tables-4
4505
[ACC Correction:Bright]
5
Adjusts the offset correction for light areas of the ACC pattern.
405
5. System Maintenance
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong) *ENG
0: MTF Off
-005
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
-009 Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
406
Main SP Tables-4
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong) *ENG
0: MTF Off
-005
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
-009 Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
-010 Sets the erasure level of textures. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. This
SP (suffix "-010") only exists in SP4580, 4582 and 4583.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong) *ENG
0: MTF Off
-005
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
407
5. System Maintenance
-009 Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
5
[Scanner Hard Error]
4647
Displays the result of the SBU connection check.
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 Power-ON - 0: OK, Other: SBU connection check failure
If the SBU connection check fails, SC144 occurs.
4688 Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF.
Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different.
001 Lamp OFF Executes the scanner free run of shading movement
with exposure lamp on or off.
-
002 Lamp ON Press "OFF" to stop this free run. Otherwise, the free
run lasts.
408
Main SP Tables-4
- - [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
This SP outputs the final data read at the end of ACC execution.
4902
A zero is returned if there was an error reading the data.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
409
5. System Maintenance
Performs a write and read check of the ASICs on the BCU board and displays the result.
Performs an image path check on the BCU board and displays the result.
410
Main SP Tables-4
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Text priority
001 High Compression PDF *ENG
1: Normal
2: Photo priority
5
[White Paper Detect Level]
4996 Selects the threshold level of the original background density. Increasing this threshold level
machine easily judge that an original is white.
[0 to 6 / 3 / 1 /step]
001 - *ENG 0: lightest
6: Darkest
411
5. System Maintenance
Main SP Tables-5
SP5-XXX (Mode)
0: mm (Europe/Asia)
001 0:mm 1:inch *CTL
1: inch (USA)
[Accounting Counter]
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 Counter Method *CTL 0: Developments
1: Prints
[Paper Display]
5047
Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 Backing Paper *CTL
0: OFF, 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] Alphanumeric
5051 1 - *CTL 0: ON
1: OFF
[Display IP Address]
5055
Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD.
412
Main SP Tables-5
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 - *CTL
0: OFF 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 - *CTL
0: Not display, 1: Display
001 - *CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
5
0: Not display, 1: Display
413
5. System Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 - *CTL
0: Not display, 1: Display
5067 Selects the service maintenance or user maintenance for each PM parts.
If the user service is selected, PM alart is displayed on the LCD.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: No
PCU:Bk *CTL
1: Yes
001 2: Yes except By-pass
Specifies whether the counter is doubled for A3/DLT. "Yes" counts except from the bypass
tray. When "Yes" is selected, A3 and DLT paper are counted twice, that is A4 x2 and LT x2
respectively.
414
Main SP Tables-5
[Mode Clear Opt. Counter [0: Yes (removed)/ 1: Standby (installed but not
5120 *CTL
Removal] used)/ 2: No (not removed)]
This program updates the information on the optional counter. When you install or remove
001
an optional counter, check the settings.
This program specifies when the counter goes up. The settings refer to "paper feed" and
001
"paper exit" respectively.
415
5. System Maintenance
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: 8 1/2" x 13" (Foolscap)
5126 [F Size Original Setting] *ENG
1: 8 1/4" x 13" (Folio)
2: 8" x 13" (F)
Determines whether the transfer sheet from the by-pass tray is used or not.
5 001 Normally the paper length for sub scanning paper from the by-pass tray is limited to 600
mm, but this can be extended with this SP to 1260 mm.
5162 [App. Switch Method] *CTL [0: Soft Key Set/ 1: Hard Key Set]
001 This program specifies the switch that selects an application program.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
Fax Printing Mode at Optional
001 *CTL 0: Automatic printing
Counter Off
1: No automatic printing
[CE Login]
5169 If you will change the printer bit switches, you must log in to service mode with this SP before
you go into the printer SP mode.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 - *CTL 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
416
Main SP Tables-5
[Size Adjust]
5181
Adjusts the paper size for each tray.
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
002 Tray 1: 2 *ENG
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
003 Tray 1: 3 *ENG
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
004 Tray 1: 4 *ENG
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ] 5
005 Tray 2: 1 *ENG
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
006 Tray 2: 2 *ENG
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
007 Tray 2: 3 *ENG
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
008 Tray 2: 4 *ENG
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
009 Tray 3: 1 *ENG
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
010 Tray 3: 2 *ENG
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
011 Tray 3: 3 *ENG
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
012 Tray 3: 4 *ENG
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 to 2 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
013 Tray 4: 1 *ENG
0: A4LEF, 1: LTLEF
417
5. System Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
014 Tray 4: 2 *ENG
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
015 Tray 4: 3 *ENG
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
016 Tray 4: 4 *ENG
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
5186 Enables or disables the prevention for RK4 (accounting device) disconnection.
If the RK4 is disconnected for 10 seconds when this SP is set to "1 (Enable)", the machine
automatically jams a sheet of paper and stops.
5 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001 - *ENG 0: Disable
1: Enable
[Copy NV Version]
5188
Displays the version number of the NVRAM on the controller board.
001 - *CTL -
This program adjusts the position of the second side page numbers.
A " value" moves the page number positions to the left edge.
A "+ value" moves the page number positions to the right edge.
418
Main SP Tables-5
[Set Time]
Adjusts the RTC (real time clock) time setting for the local time zone.
Examples: For Japan (+9 GMT), enter 540 (9 hours x 60 min.)
DOM: +540 (Tokyo)
5302 NA: -300 (New York)
EU: + 60 (Paris)
CH: +480 (Peking)
TW: +480 (Taipei)
AS: +480 (Hong Kong)
Make sure that both SP5-307-3 and -4 are correctly set. Otherwise, this SP is not
activated even if this SP is set to "1".
419
5. System Maintenance
420
Main SP Tables-5
421
5. System Maintenance
422
Main SP Tables-5
[User Authentication]
423
5. System Maintenance
Enables or disables the color copy limitation for each copy mode when the user
authentication is "ON".
0: Enable (default), 1: Disable
Bit0: B/W mode
002
Bit1: Mono color mode
Bit2: Two colors mode
Bit3: Full color mode
Bit4: Automatic color mode
Bit5 to 7: Reserved
051 SDK1
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF
061 SDK2 *CTL Determines whether certification is required
before a user can use the SDK application.
071 SDK3
424
Main SP Tables-5
001 Job Permit Setting *CTL 0: Disabled. Cancels operation without a user
code.
1: Enabled. Allows operation without a user
code.
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 / step]
0: Alarm off
001 PM Alarm Level *CTL
1 to 9999: Alarm goes off when Value (1 to
9999) x 1000 > PM counter
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: No alarm sounds
002 Original Count Alarm *CTL
1: Alarm sounds after the number of originals
passing through the ARDF > 10,000
425
5. System Maintenance
Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included).
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
0: Zero (Off)
001
1: Low (2.5K jams)
2: Medium (3K jams)
3: High (6K jams)
[Error Alarm]
426
Main SP Tables-5
427
5. System Maintenance
[SC/Alarm Setting]
5515 With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an SC call when an SC error
occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC call is not issued when an SC error occurs.
001 SC Call
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
002 Service Parts Near End Call
0: Off
003 Service Parts End Call
1: On
004 User Call
Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
428
Main SP Tables-5
Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
005
R-M *ENG
128: Darkest density 5
Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: ACS, Colour, Black & White, Two Colour, Single
- *CTL
001 colour
1: ACD, Full Colour, Black & White
429
5. System Maintenance
Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX settings,
5 007 Fax application
local storage file numbers, and off-hook timer.
Initializes the scanner defaults for the scanner and all the
009 Scanner application
scanner SP modes.
014 Clear DCS Setting Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control Service) settings.
430
Main SP Tables-5
018 SRM Memory Clr Initializes the SRM (System Resource Manager) settings.
002 NOT 0 -
003 RET. -
004 EXE.ALL
005 EXE.K
006 EXE.M
007 EXE.C
008 EXE.Y
[SC Reset]
Turn the main switch off and on after resetting the SC code.
431
5. System Maintenance
Service *CTL -
001 Sets the telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List, which can be printed with the users "Counter" menu.
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Facsimile *CTL -
5 002 Sets the fax or telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List.
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Supply *CTL -
003 Use this to input the telephone number of your supplier for consumables. Enter the number
and press #.
Operation *CTL -
004 Use this to input the telephone number of your sales agency. Enter the number and press
#.
I/F Setting
432
Main SP Tables-5
CE Call
Function Flag
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
NOTE: This SP setting is changed to "1" after @Remote registor has been completed.
5
SSL Disable
Uses or does not use the RCG certification by SSL when calling the RCG.
007 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
008 Specifies the connect timeout interval when calling the RCG.
[1 to 90 / 10 / 1 second /step]
009 Specifies the write timeout interval when calling the RCG.
010 Specifies the read timeout interval when calling the RCG.
Port 80 Enable
433
5. System Maintenance
RCG C Registed
0: Internet connection
1: Dial-up connection
Use Proxy
062 This SP setting determines if the proxy server is used when the machine communicates with
the service center.
Proxy Host
This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication between Embedded
RC Gate-N and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or display the customer proxy server
address. The address is necessary to set up Embedded RC Gate-N.
063
The address display is limited to 128 characters. Characters beyond the 128
character are ignored.
This address is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
434
Main SP Tables-5
This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication between Embedded
064 RC Gate-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to set up Embedded RC Gate-N.
This port number is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
065
The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy Password
5
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification password.
066
The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
435
5. System Maintenance
CERT: Up State
The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received from the GW
1
URL and certification is presently being updated.
The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
2
successful update.
3 The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failed update.
The period of the certification has expired and new request for an update is being
4
sent to the GW URL.
5 11
A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue certification setting
is in progress for the rescue GW connection.
The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
067 12
certification update request.
The notification of the request for certification update has completed successfully,
13 and the system is waiting for the certification update request from the rescue GW
URL.
The notification of the certification request has been received from the rescue GW
14
controller, and the certification is being stored.
The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of the successful
15
completion of this event.
The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the
16
failure of this event.
The certification update request has been received from the GW URL, the GW URL
17 was notified of the results of the update after it was completed, but a certification
error has been received, and the rescue certification is being recorded.
The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL is being
18
notified of the failure of the certification update.
436
Main SP Tables-5
CERT: Error
Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update of the
certification.
1 Request for certification update in progress. The current certification has expired.
068
2 An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification has expired.
087 CERT: Macro Ver. Displays the macro version of the @Remote certification.
088 CERT: PAC Ver. Displays the PAC version of the @Remote certification.
437
5. System Maintenance
Displays the start time of the period for which the current
093 CERT: Valid Start
@Remote certification is enabled.
Selection Country
150
Not used
Selection Dial/Push
153
Not used
Dial Up Password
157
Not used
438
Main SP Tables-5
Access Point
163
Not used
Line Connecting
164
Not used
Retransmission Limit 5
174
Not used
FAX TX Priority -
187
Not used
Regist: Status
Displays a number that indicates the status of the @Remote service device.
0: Neither the @Remote device nor Embedded RCG Gate is set.
1: The Embedded RCG Gate is being set. Only Box registration is completed. In this status,
201 @Remote device cannot communicate with this device.
2: The Embedded RCG Gate is set. In this status, the @Remote device cannot communicate
with this device.
3: The @Remote device is being set. In this status the Embedded RCG Gate cannot be set.
4: The @Remote module has not started.
203 Confirm Execute Executes the confirmation request to the @Remote Gateway.
439
5. System Maintenance
Displays a number that indicates the result of the confirmation executed with SP5816-203.
0: Succeeded
1: Confirmation number error
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
6: Communication error
7: Certification update error
8: Other error
9: Confirmation executing
5 Confirm Place
205 Displays the result of the notification sent to the device from the Gateway in answer to the
confirmation request. Displayed only when the result is registered at the Gateway.
Register Result
Error Code
208 Displays a number that describes the error code that was issued when either SP5816-204
or SP5816-207 was executed.
440
Main SP Tables-5
441
5. System Maintenance
5824 Uploads the UP and SP mode data (except for counters and the serial number) from the
NVRAM to an SD card. For details, see the "NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the
"System Maintenance Reference" of the Field Service Manual.
001 - # -
5825 Downloads the UP and SP mode data from an SD card to the NVRAM. For details, see the
"NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the "System Maintenance Reference" of the Field
Service Manual.
001 - # -
442
Main SP Tables-5
443
5. System Maintenance
444
Main SP Tables-5
445
5. System Maintenance
072 Reduction for Copy B&W Text 0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4
073 Reduction for Copy B&W Other 0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4
446
Main SP Tables-5
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
081 Format for Copy Color
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
082 Format for Copy B&W Text
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
5
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
083 Format for Copy B&W Other
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
084 Format for Printer Color
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
085 Format for Printer B&W
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
086 Format for Printer B&W HQ
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
091 Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document management server via
the MLB with JPEG selected as the format.
Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed.
102 Primary srv scheme This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
103 Primary srv port number This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
447
5. System Maintenance
104 Primary srv URL path This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
112 Secondary srv scheme This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
113 Secondary srv port number This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
114 Secondary srv URL path This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
120 Default Reso Rate Switch This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
121 Selects the resolution for color copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
122 Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
448
Main SP Tables-5
[1 to 11 or 13 / 11 or 13 / 1 /step]
Channel MAX *CTL Europe/Asia: 1 to 13
NA/ Asia: 1 to 11
Sets the maximum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
006 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the maximum end of the range for each area. Adjust the upper 4 bits to set the maximum
number of channels.
[1 to 11 or 13 / 1 / 1 /step]
Channel MIN *CTL Europe: 1 to 13
NA/ Asia: 1 to 11
5
Sets the minimum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
007 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the minimum end of the range for each area. Adjust the lower 4 bits to set the minimum
number of channels.
[0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -]
0 x FF to Auto [Default]
0 x 11 55M Fix
0 x 10 48M Fix
0 x 0F 36M Fix
0 x 0E 18M Fix
0 x 0D 12M Fix
008 Transmission Speed *CTL 0 x 0B 9M Fix
0 x 0A 6M Fix
0 x 07 11M Fix
0 x 05 5.5M Fix
0 x 08 1M Fix
0 x 13 0 x FE (reserved)
0 x 12 72M (reserved)
0 x 09 22M (reserved)
449
5. System Maintenance
450
Main SP Tables-5
5
5844 [USB]
451
5. System Maintenance
006 Use this setting to determine the length of time the prompt message is displayed when a
test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and an external
device.
008 Specifies the IP address assigned to the computer designated to function as the secondary
delivery server of Scan Router. This SP allows only the setting of the IP address without
reference to the DNS setting.
Allows changing the model of the delivery server registered by the I/O device.
0: Unknown
5 009 1: SG1 Provided
2: SG1 Package
3: SG2 Provided
4: SG2 Package
Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered.
452
Main SP Tables-5
Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered.
011
Bit7 = 1 Address book usage limitation (Limitation for each authorized user)
Bit6 = 1 RDH authorization link
Bit5 to 0: Not used
Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending error.
022
[0 to 1 / 0 / -]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
001 Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The value is only
displayed and cannot be changed. This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394
EUI. The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary.
002 Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer directory. Execute
this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery server is unstable. After clearing the
ID, the ID will be established again automatically by cycling the machine off and on.
003 Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle.
If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is cleared, and the
data (excluding user code information) is displayed.
453
5. System Maintenance
5 This SP must be executed immediately after installation of an HDD unit in a basic machine
that previously had no HDD. The first time the machine is powered on with the new HDD
installed, the system automatically takes the address book from the NVRAM and writes it
onto the new HDD. However, the new address book on the HDD can be accessed only
by the system administrator at this stage. Executing this SP by the service technician
immediately after power on grants full address book access to all users.
Procedure
041
1. Turn the machine off.
2. Install a new HDD.
3. Turn the machine on.
4. The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD automatically.
5. However, at this point the address book can be accessed by only the system
administrator or key operator.
6. Enter the SP mode and do SP5846-041. After this SP executes successfully, any user
can access the address book.
454
Main SP Tables-5
051 Backup All Addr Book Uploads all directory information to the SD card.
052 Restore All Addr Book Downloads all directory information from the SD card.
455
5. System Maintenance
Search Option
This SP uses bit switches to set up the fuzzy search options for the UCS local address book.
Bit: Meaning
0: Checks both upper/lower case characters
060
1: Japan Only
2: Japan Only
3: Japan Only
4 to 7: Not Used
Complexity Option 1
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book.
Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to upper case and sets the length of the
5 password.
062 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1 /step]
SP5847-1 through SP5847-8 changes the default settings of image data transferred
externally by the Net File page reference function.
5847 [ 0 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step]
SP5847-21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files handled by NetFile.
"Net files" are jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the
DeskTopBinder software.
456
Main SP Tables-5
021 Sets the default value for the quality of JPEG images sent as NetFile pages. This function
is available only with the MLB (Media Link Board) option installed.
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]
457
5. System Maintenance
[Bluetooth Mode]
5851 Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key.
[0:Public] [1: Private]
Use this SP to download the fixed stamp data stored in the firmware of the ROM and copy
it to the HDD. This SP can be executed as many times as required. This SP must be executed
5853
after replacing or formatting the hard disks.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step]
002 Local Port *CTL 0: Disable
1: Enable
458
Main SP Tables-5
002 Selects the storage device to save debug logs information when the conditions set with
SP5-858 are satisfied.
[ 2 to 3 / 2 / 1 /step]
Save to HDD
Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the HDD.
005
A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on the SD Card.
Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to
5
each SD Card.
Save to SD Card
006
Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the SD card.
5858 These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to the destination
selected by SP5857-002.
SP5858-3 stores one SC specified by number. Refer to Section 4 for a list of SC error codes.
459
5. System Maintenance
001 Key 1
002 Key 2
003 Key 3
004 Key 4
These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log files for
005 Key 5 functions that use common memory on the controller
board.
006 Key 6
[9999999 to 9999999 / 0 / ]
007 Key 7
008 Key 8
009 Key 9
010 Key 10
460
Main SP Tables-5
Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during reception. The
received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail is not received during this
prescribed time.
Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the validated account
after the SMTP server is validated.
0: No. "From" item not switched.
1: Yes. "From item switched. 5
025 SMTP Auth. Direct Setting [0 or 1 / 0 / ]
461
5. System Maintenance
5 Initialize *CTL -
462
Main SP Tables-5
463
5. System Maintenance
0: OFF, 1: ON
Bit Meaning
0: Forbid all document server access (1)
1: Forbid user mode access (1)
2: Forbid print function (1)
020 Document Server ACC Ctrl *CTL
3: Forbid fax TX (1)
4: Forbid scan sending (1)
5: Forbid downloading (1)
6: Forbid delete (1)
5 7: Reserved
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Signature for each e-mail
Set Signature *CTL
1: Signature for all e-mails
100
2: No signature
Selects whether the signature is added to the scanned documents with the WIM when they
are transmitted by an e-mail.
464
Main SP Tables-5
5896 [Copy/PrinterPriority]
- [0 or 1 / 0 / -]
001 Selects the priority memory type. The larger memory is used for the selected mode (copy or
printer).
0: Copy priority, 1: Printer priority
465
5. System Maintenance
Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play. This information
is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these names should be registered again.
001
After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time. When the setting
is completed, the beeper sounds five times.
5 Enables and disables the document server. This is a security measure that prevents image
001 data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After changing this setting, you must
switch the main switch off and on to enable the new setting.
[Cherry Server]
5974
Specifies which version of ScanRouter, "Lite" or "Full", is installed.
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
001 Cherry Server *CTL
0: Lite, 1: Full
[Device Setting]
5985 The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this SP to enable
and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB functions built into the controller
board, these SP codes must be set to "1".
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation
When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is
limited only for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication.
001 On Board NIC
466
Main SP Tables-5
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
002 On Board USB
0: Disable, 1: Enable
006 Non-Default - -
022 Scanner SP -
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
001 fast/silent -
0: Off, 1: On
467
5. System Maintenance
468
Main SP Tables-6
Main SP Tables-6
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)
Adjusts the side-to-side and leading registration of originals with the ARDF.
Adjusts the amount of paper buckle to correct original skew for the front and rear sides.
5
005 Buckle: Duplex: 1st
*ENG [-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]
006 Buckle: Duplex: 2nd
469
5. System Maintenance
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
*ENG 0: Setting 1
1: Setting 2
5 Setting 1 Setting 2
470
Main SP Tables-6
471
5. System Maintenance
Main SP Tables-7
SP7-XXX (Data Log)
[Total SC Counter]
7401
Displays the number of SC codes detected.
[SC History]
5 The 10 most recently detected SC Codes are not displayed on the screen, but can be seen
on the SMC (logging) outputs.
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
*CTL -
006 Latest 5
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9
472
Main SP Tables-7
473
5. System Maintenance
245 Finisher Tray Lift Motor *CTL For details, p.693 "Jam
246 Finisher Jogger Motor *CTL Detection"
474
Main SP Tables-7
001 At Power On
004 Registration: ON
For details, p.693 "Jam
005 Paper Exit: ON *CTL
Detection"
053 Skew Correction: OFF
006 A5 LEF
014 B5 LEF
038 LT LEF
132 A3 SEF
133 A4 SEF
141 B4 SEF
142 B5 SEF
164 LG SEF
166 LT SEF
255 Others
475
5. System Maintenance
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
*CTL -
006 Latest 5
007 Latest 6
5 008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9
001 Latest
002 Latest-1
003 Latest-2
004 Latest-3
005 Latest-4
*CTL -
006 Latest-5
007 Latest-6
008 Latest-7
009 Latest-8
010 Latest-9
476
Main SP Tables-7
Displays the number of sheets printed for each current maintenance unit.
PM counters click up based on the number of A4 (LT) LEF size sheets printed. Therefore,
the A3 (DLT) Double Count is activated. The Double Count cannot be deactivated.
-001 to When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed.
-021 Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous
(SP7-906-1 to 21) and is reset to "0".
The total number of sheets printed with the last unit replaced can be checked with
SP7-906-1 to 21.
001 Paper
477
5. System Maintenance
Displays the number of revolutions of motors or clutches for each current maintenance unit.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 revolution/step ]
-031 to When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed.
-048 Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous
(SP7-906-31 to 48) and is reset to "0". The total number of revolutions made with the last
unit replaced can be checked with SP7-906-31 to 48.
478
Main SP Tables-7
479
5. System Maintenance
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
Displays the value given by the following formula:
(Current revolution Target revolution) 100. This shows how much of the units expected
-061 to lifetime has been used up.
-078
The Rotation% counter is based on rotations, not prints. If the number of rotations reaches
the limit, the machine enters the end condition for that unit. If the print count lifetime is
reached first, the machine also enters the end condition, even though the R% counter is still
less than 100%.
480
Main SP Tables-7
481
5. System Maintenance
001 Paper
002 PCU: Bk
003 PCU: C
004 PCU: M
5 005 PCU: Y
012 Developer: Bk
013 Developer: C
014 Developer: M
015 Developer: Y
482
Main SP Tables-7
100 All
001 - *CTL -
- *CTL -
001 - *CTL -
001 - *CTL -
483
5. System Maintenance
7852 Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on the scanning
glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter. Counting is done only if SP4-020-1
(ADF Scan Glass Dust Check) is switched on.
[Replacement Counter]
7853
Displays the PM parts replacement number.
484
Main SP Tables-7
[Coverage Range]
-001 to Displays the number of sheets printed with the previous maintenance units.
-020 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 page/step ]
485
5. System Maintenance
-031 to Displays the number of revolutions for motors or clutches in the previous maintenance units.
-050 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]
486
Main SP Tables-7
-061 to Displays the number of sheets printed with the previous maintenance unit or toner cartridge.
-080 [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ]
487
5. System Maintenance
488
Main SP Tables-7
489
5. System Maintenance
5
[Toner Bottle M]
7932
Displays the toner bottle information for M.
490
Main SP Tables-7
5
[Toner Bottle C]
7933
Displays the toner bottle information for C.
491
5. System Maintenance
5
[Toner Bottle Y]
7934
Displays the toner bottle information for Y.
492
Main SP Tables-7
493
5. System Maintenance
494
Main SP Tables-7
495
5. System Maintenance
496
Main SP Tables-7
497
5. System Maintenance
498
Main SP Tables-7
7952
[PM Yield Setting]
5
Adjusts the unit yield of each PM unit.
499
5. System Maintenance
Day Threshold:
5 027
Development Unit: M
*EGN
Day Threshold:
028 *EGN
Development Unit: Y
033 Day Threshold: ITB Unit *EGN These threshold days are used for @Remote
alarms.
Day Threshold: ITB
034 *EGN
Cleaning Unit
500
Main SP Tables-7
045
Rotation: Development Unit:
*EGN 5
Y
501
5. System Maintenance
062 Day Threshold:PTR Unit Adjusts the threshold day of the near end for each
PM unit.
063 Day Thresh:ITB T-Collect Bttl
*EGN [1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step]
Day Thresh:PCU T-Collect These threshold days are used for @Remote
064
Bttl alarms.
001 T<=0
002 0<T<=5:0<=H<30
003 0<T<=5:30<=H<70
502
Main SP Tables-7
001 -
503
5. System Maintenance
Main SP Tables-8
Input and Output Check Tables
Bit No. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Result 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1
5 Copier
Reading
5803 Description
0 1
504
Main SP Tables-8
ID/MUSIC Sn Shutter HP Sn
5803 22 HP Not HP
(PTR Contact Sensor)
5803 23 HVPS:CB - - 5
5803 24 HVPS:T - -
Not HP
5803 38 ITB Contact HP Sensor HP (Contact)
(not contact)
505
5. System Maintenance
5803 56 DIP SW - -
506
Main SP Tables-8
Models Bit
507
5. System Maintenance
A4 SEF A4 SEF 0 1 1
B5 SEF B5 SEF 1 1 0
A5 LEF A5 LEF 1 0 1
*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-002
(Tray 1) or SP 5-181-006 (Tray 2).
*2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-003
(Tray 1) or SP 5-181-007 (Tray 2).
*3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-001
(Tray 1) or SP 5-181-005 (Tray 2).
*4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-004
(Tray 1) or SP 5-181-008 (Tray 2).
508
Main SP Tables-8
1 0 0 1 1 LT LEF A4 LEF
*1: The paper size (LT or LG) can be selected with SP1-007-001.
Table 3: APS Original Size Detection:
F4
8.5" x 13", 8.25" x 13",
or 8" x 13" 8.5" x 14" O X X O O 00000011
SP 5126 controls the size
that is detected
B5 LEF - O O X X X 00000000
B5 SEF - X X X O X 00000010
5.5" x 8.5",
A5 LEF/ SEF X X X X X 00000000
8.5" x 5.5"
Models Bit
509
5. System Maintenance
A4 SEF A4 SEF 1 0 0 0
B5 SEF B5 SEF 0 0 1 1
A5 LEF A5 LEF 0 1 0 0
A5 SEF A5 SEF 1 1 0 1
*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-010 (Tray
3) or SP 5-181-014 (Tray 4).
*2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-011 (Tray
3) or SP 5-181-015 (Tray 4).
*3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-009
(Tray 3) or SP 5-181-013 (Tray 4).
*4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-012
(Tray 3) or SP 5-181-016 (Tray 4).
ARDF (D366)
Reading
6007 Description
0 1
6007 1 Original Length Sn1 (B5 Sn) Paper not detected Paper detected
6007 2 Original Length Sn2 (A4 Sn) Paper not detected Paper detected
6007 3 Original Length Sn3 (LG Sn) Paper not detected Paper detected
510
Main SP Tables-8
Reading
6120 Description
0 1
511
5. System Maintenance
512
Main SP Tables-8
513
5. System Maintenance
514
Main SP Tables-8
515
5. System Maintenance
516
Main SP Tables-8
517
5. System Maintenance
518
Main SP Tables-8
ARDF (D366)
519
5. System Maintenance
Main SP Tables-9
Printer Service Mode
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
5 bit 2 DFU - -
Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will never occur.
Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot ( p.560 "Card
Save Function").
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the edges of the
printable area.
520
Main SP Tables-9
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not already have a
Collate Type configured.
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
521
5. System Maintenance
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as HP4000/HP8000.
In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually "<ESC>*r0A") will be changed
to "<ESC>*r1A"
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
5
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
If enabled, the simplex pages of IPDS jobs will be printed on the front side because of
printing on the back side of the page. This might reduce printing speed.
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
522
Main SP Tables-9
If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and Punch Type
bit 0 from the operation panel. The available types will depend on the device and configured
options.
After enabling the function, the settings will appear under:
"User Tools > Printer Features > System"
If a paper size or type mismatch occurs during the printing of multiple copies, only a
single copy is output by default. Using this BitSw, the device can be configured to print
all copies even if a paper mismatch occurs. 5
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 4 Increase max number of the stored jobs to 1000 Disable Enable (1000)
jobs. (100)
Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD via Job
Type settings to 1000. The default is 100.
Enable: All print jobs will be output face-up in the destination tray.
If enabled, the image rotation will be performed as they were in the specifications of
older models for the binding of pages of mixed orientation jobs.
The old models are below:
- PCL: Pre-04A models
- PS/PDF/RPCS:Pre-05S models
523
5. System Maintenance
bit 7 1: Enable
Letterhead mode printing 0: Disable
(Duplex)
bit 0 If enabled, simplex pages (in mixed simplex/duplex PS/PCL5 jobs only) and the last
page of an odd paged duplex job (PS, PCL5, PCL6), are always routed through the
5 duplex unit. Not having to switch paper paths increases the print speed slightly.
bit 1
DFU - -
to 7
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
Enable: BW jobs submitted without a user code will be printed even if usercode
authentication is enabled.
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
524
Main SP Tables-9
"Disabled
PDL Auto Detection timeout of jobs submitted via "Enabled
USB or Parallel Port (IEEE 1284). (Immediatel
(10 seconds)"
y)"
bit 0
To be used if PDL auto-detection fails. A failure of PDL autodetection doesn't necessarily
mean that the job can't be printed. This bit switch tells the device whether to time-out
immediately (default) upon failure or to wait 10 seconds.
bit 1 DFU - -
This bitsw causes the device to revert to the behavior of previous generations. It only
takes effect if "Bypass Tray Setting Priority" = "Driver/Command".
Previous spec (bitsw=1): If a standard sized paper mismatch occurred in the bypass
tray, the MFP always prompted for SEF paper.
If this bitsw=0 (default) then in the event of a standard sized paper mismatch, the MFP
will always prompt for paper of the rotation (SEF/LEF) determined by the MFP bypass
tray paper setting or by the bypass tray sensor.
Bit 4 DFU
- -
to 7
525
5. System Maintenance
Print Summary
1004 1
Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings).
Disp. Version
1005 1
Displays the version of the controller firmware.
Enables and disables the document server. When you select "0," the document server is
5 1006 1 enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service Mode SP5-967. When you select
"1," the document server is enabled regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967.
[Data Recall]
1101 Recalls a set of gamma settings. This can be either a) the factory setting, b) the previous
setting, or c) the current setting.
1101 1 Factory
1101 2 Previous
*CTL
1101 3 Current
1101 4 ACC
[Resolution Setting]
1102
Selects the printing mode (resolution) for the printer gamma adjustment.
2400x600 Photo, 1800x600 Photo, 600 x 600 Photo, 2400x600 Text, 1800x600, Text,
1102 1
600x600 Text
[Test Page]
1103
Prints the test page to check the color balance before and after the gamma adjustment.
526
Main SP Tables-9
[Gamma Adjustment]
1104
Adjusts the printer gamma for the mode selected in the "Mode Selection" menu.
1105 Stores the print gamma adjusted with the "Gamma Adj." menu item as the current setting.
Before the machine stores the new "current setting", it moves the data currently stored as the
"current setting" to the "previous setting" memory storage location.
[Toner Limit]
1106
Adjusts the maximum toner amount for image development.
527
5. System Maintenance
Scanner SP Mode
1001 5 - *CTL -
[Compression Type]
1004
5 Selects the compression type for binary picture processing.
[1 to 3 / 1 / 1/step ]
1004 1 Compression Type *CTL
1: MH, 2: MR, 3: MMR
[Erase margin]
1005 Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image.
If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. This SP is activated
only when the machine uses TWAIN scanning.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
1009 [Remote scan disable] *CTL
0: enable, 1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
1010 [Non Display Clear Light PDF] *CTL
0: Display, 1: No display
528
Main SP Tables-9
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
1012 [UserInfo release] *CTL
0: No, 1: Yes
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
1013 [Multimedia Function Setting] *CTL
0: OFF, 1: ON
529
5. System Maintenance
Firmware Update
To update the firmware for this machine, you must have the new version of the firmware downloaded onto
an SD (Secure Digital) Card. The SD Card is inserted into SD Card Slot 2 on the left rear side of the controller
box.
Type of Firmware
530
Firmware Update
Data Overwrite
Security application Security SD card HDD Format Option
Security
An SD card is a precision device. Always observe the following precautions when you handle SD cards:
5
Always switch the machine off before you insert an SD card. Never insert the SD card into the slot
with the power on.
Do not remove the SD card from the service slot after the power has been switched on.
Never switch the machine off while the firmware is downloading from the SD card.
Keep SD cards in a safe location where they are not exposed to high temperature, high humidity, or
exposure to direct sunlight.
Always handle SD cards with care. Do not bend or scratch them. Do not let the SD card get exposed
to shock or vibration.
Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked when you download an application to
it. If not, downloading fails and a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware
upgrade.
Keep the following points in mind when you use the firmware update software:
"Upload" means to send data from the machine to the SD card. "Download" means to send data from
the SD card to the machine.
To select an item on the LCD, touch the appropriate button on the soft touch-screen of the LCD, or,
press the appropriate number key on the 10-key pad of the operation panel. For example, when "Exit
(0)" shows on the screen you can touch the Exit button on the screen, or, press the button on the
operation panel of the copier.
Make sure that the machine is disconnected from the network to prevent a print job for arriving while
the firmware update is in progress before you start the firmware update procedure.
531
5. System Maintenance
Updating Firmware
Preparation
If the SD card is blank, copy the entire "romdata" folder onto the SD card.
If the card already contains the "romdata" folder, copy the "D104" folder onto the card.
If the card already contains folders up to "D104", copy the necessary firmware files (e.g. D104xxxx.fwu)
into this folder.
Do not put multiple machine firmware programs on the same SD card. Copy the only model firmware
you want.
5 Updating Procedure
1. Turn the main power switch off.
2. Remove the slot cover ( x 1).
3. Remove the Java VM card from SD slot 2
4. Insert the SD card into SD slot 2. Make sure the label on the SD card faces the rear side of the machine.
5. Slowly push the SD card into the slot so it locks in place. You will hear it click. Make sure the SD card
locks in place.
To remove the SD, push it in to unlock the spring lock. Then release it so it pops out of the slot.
6. Disconnect the network cable from the copier if the machine is connected to a network.
7. Switch the main power switch on. After about 45 seconds, the initial version update screen appears
on the LCD in English.
8. On the screen, touch the button or press the corresponding number key on the operation panel to
select the item in the menu that you want to update.
Tells you the number of the module and name of the version currently installed.
ROM:
The first line is the module number, the second line the version name.
Tells you the number of the module and name version on the SD card. The first
NEW:
line is the module number, the second line the version name.
532
Firmware Update
Controller, engine and operation panel firmware cannot be updated at the same time. It is
recommended to update firmware modules one by one.
9. Touch "UpDate (#)" (or ) to start the update.
The progress bar does not show for the operation panel firmware after you touch "OpPanel".
The power on key flashes on and off at 0.5 s intervals when the LCDC firmware is updating. The
power key flashes on and off at 3 s intervals when the update is finished.
10. The "Update is Done" message appears on the operation panel after completing the updating. The
message differs depending on the firmware that has been updated.
11. Switch the copier main power switch off when you see the "Update is Done" message or follow the
procedure that is displayed on the operation panel.
12. Press in the SD card to release it. Then remove it from the slot.
13. Install the Java card in SD slot 2, and then attach the SD slot cover ( x 1).
5
14. Switch the copier on for normal operation.
Error Messages
An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during the download.
The error code consists of the letter "E" and a number. The example above shows error "E24" displayed.
For details, refer to the Error Message Table. ( "Handling Firmware Update Error")
533
5. System Maintenance
534
Firmware Update
An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during a download. The error code consists of
the letter "E" and a number ("E20", for example).
20 Cannot map logical address Make sure the SD card is inserted correctly.
Error occurred when ROM update Controller program abnormal. If the second attempt fails,
23
program started replace controller board.
Data incorrect for continuous Insert the SD card with the remaining data required for
31
download the download, the re-start the procedure.
Data incorrect after download Execute the recovery procedure for the intended module
32
interrupted download, then repeat the installation procedure.
33 Incorrect SD card version Incorrect ROM data on the SD card, or data is corrupted.
Module mismatch - Correct SD update data is incorrect. Acquire the correct data
34
module is not on the SD card) (Japan, Overseas, OEM, etc.) then install again.
535
5. System Maintenance
Operation panel module Replace the update data for the module on the SD card
42
download failed and try again, or replace the LCDC.
Stamp data module download Replace the update data for the module on the SD card
43
failed and try again, or replace the hard disks.
5 Controller module download Replace the update data for the module on the SD card
44
failed and tray again, or replace controller board.
1. Turn the main power off, then remove the SD slot cover ( x 1), and remove the Java VM card from
SD slot 2.
2. Insert the Java VM card to the SD card writer that is connected to PC.
3. Make sure which drive is assigned for the SD card.
4. Decompress the downloaded update file, then two files exist that one file is ".exe" file extension and
the other is ".bat" file extension.
5. Double click the ".bat" file then command prompt screen is appeared.
6. The first command line is shown as
"Please input drive letter of SD card [a x]:"
Then enter the SD card drive name, and press "Enter" key.
536
Firmware Update
7. "Press any key to continue" is appeared, then press "Enter" key again. The updating to the SD card
starts.
8. "Press any key to continue" is appeared again, then press "Enter" key. The command prompt screen
is disappeared automatically if the updating is successful.
9. Remove the Java VM card from the SD card writer after going off the access lamp on the SD card
writer.
10. Insert the Java VM card in the SD slot 2 of the machine and turn the main power on.
537
5. System Maintenance
10. Copy the App2Me Provider folder into the specified path for the VM card. The path is:
"SD_Card Drive\ sdk\dsdk\dist\337051920"
11. Turn the SD card label face to the rear of the machine, and then push it slowly into SD slot 2 (lower
slot) until you hear a click.
12. Attach the SD slot cover ( x 1).
13. Turn the main power switch on.
14. Press [User Tools] on the operation panel.
15. Touch the "Extended Feature Settings" button twice.
16. Touch the "Extended Feature Info" tab on the LCD.
17. Touch the "App2Me" line.
18. Set the setting of the "Auto Start" to "On".
19. Touch the "Exit" button.
5 20. Exit the [User Tools/Counter] settings.
538
Firmware Update
3. Turn the SD-card label face of the latest version Brower Unit [A] to the front of the machine. Then push
it slowly into SD slot 2 until you hear a click.
4. Plug in and turn on the main power switch. 5
5. Push the "User Tools" key.
If an administrator setting is registered for the machine, step 5 and 6 are required. Otherwise,
skip to step 7
6. Push the "Login/ Logout" key.
7. Login with the administrator user name and password.
8. Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.
9. Touch "Uninstall" on the LCD.
10. Touch the "Browser" line
11. Confirmation message appears on the LCD.
12. Touch "Yes" to proceed.
13. Reconfirmation message appears on the LCD.
14. Touch "Yes" to uninstall the browser unit.
15. You will see "Uninstalling the extended feature... Please wait.", and then "Completed".
16. Touch "Exit" to go back to the setting screen.
17. Exit "User/Tools" setting, and then turn off the main power switch.
18. Remove the SD card from SD card slot 2.
19. Overwrite the updated program in the "sdk" folder of the browser unit application with PC.
20. Do the "Installation Procedure" to install the browser unit.
21. Remove the SD card of the latest version Brower Unit from SD slot 2.
22. Reinstall the VM card in the SD slot 2.
23. Attach the SD slot cover [A] ( x 1).
539
5. System Maintenance
Touch this button on the screen (or press on the 10-key pad) to open the
LANG. 1(1)
next screen so you can select the 1st language.
Touch this button on the screen (or press on the 10-key pad) to open the
LANG. 1(2)
next screen so you can select the 2nd language.
Touch this key on the screen (or press on the 10-key pad) to quit the update
Exit(0)
procedure and return to normal screen.
7. Touch "LANG 1(1)" to select the 1st Language. Touch "LANG (2)" to select the 2nd Language.
540
Installing Another Language
8. Touch the appropriate button on the screen (or press the number on the 10-keypad) to select a
language as the 1st (or 2nd) language.
5
If a language is already selected, it will show in reverse.
Touching "Exit (0)" returns you to the previous screen.
9. If you do not see the language that you want to select, touch " (7)" or " (9)" on the screen (or
press or ) to show more choices.
The Download Screen opens after you select a language.
The 1st or 2nd language selected for updating shows.
The following show to right of the selection:
1. The first column shows the language currently selected.
2. The 2nd column shows the language selected to replace that language.
The example below shows that the download will replace "Japanese" with "Italian" as the 1st
language.
541
5. System Maintenance
5 10. Touch "Update(#)" on the screen (or press ) to start the download.
Another screen with a progress bar does not show when the language is downloading.
The following occur at the time the language is downloading:
The operation panel switches off.
The LED on the power on key flashes rapidly.
11. After the message of installation completed has shown on the LCD, switch the copier main power
switch off. Then remove the SD card from the slot.
12. Switch the copier main power switch on to resume normal operation.
542
Reboot/System Setting Reset
You can reboot the software with one of the following two procedures:
1. Turn the main power switch off and on.
2. Press and hold down together for over 10 seconds. When the machine beeps once, release
both buttons. After Now loading. Please wait shows for a few seconds, the copy window will open.
The machine is ready for normal operation.
3. Press yes when the message prompts you to confirm that you want to reset the system settings.
4. Press exit when the message tells you that the settings have been reset.
543
5. System Maintenance
5
3. Press Yes when the message prompts you to confirm that you want to reset the Copier Document
Server settings.
4. Press exit when the message tells you that the settings have been reset.
544
Controller Self-Diagnostics
Controller Self-Diagnostics
Overview
545
5. System Maintenance
546
SD Card Appli Move
The service program SD Card Appli Move (SP5-873) lets you to copy application programs from one
SD card to another SD card.
Slot 1 and Slot 2 are used to store application programs. However, more than two optional applications
are supplied for this machine. In that case, you can move application programs from Slot 2 to Slot 1 with
the following procedure.
Consider the following limitations when you try to merge SD cards.
PostScript3 cannot be moved to the other SD card.
The destination SD card should have the largest memory size of all the application SD cards. Refer
to the following table for the memory size of each SD card.
5
Outline of SD Card Appli Move:
1. Choose a SD card with enough space.
Do not use an SD card if it has been used on a computer. Normal operation is not guaranteed
when such an SD card is used.
2. Enter SP5873 SD Card Appli Move. Then move the application from the SD Card in Slot 2 to the
card in slot 1.
3. Exit the SP mode
Use caution when you do the SD Card Appli Move procedure:
The data necessary for authentication is transferred with the application program from an SD
card to another SD card. Authentication fails if you try to use the SD card after you copy the
application program from one card to another card.
547
5. System Maintenance
Move Exec
The menu Move Exec (SP5-873-001) lets you copy application programs from the original SD card to
another SD card.
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of an application SD card on the machine. If the write protect
switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware upgrade or application
merge.
1. Turn the main switch off.
2. Make sure that an SD card is in SD Card Slot 1. The application program is copied into this SD card.
3. Insert the SD card (having stored the application program) to SD Card Slot 2. The application program
is copied from this SD card.
4. Turn the main switch on.
5. Start the SP mode.
6. Select SP5-873-001 Move Exec.
7. Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8. Turn the main switch off.
9. Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.
10. Turn the main switch on.
548
SD Card Appli Move
Undo Exec
The menu Undo Exec (SP5-873-002) lets you copy back application programs from an SD card to the
original SD card. You can use this program when, for example, you have mistakenly copied some programs
by using Move Exec (SP5-873-001).
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of an application SD card on the machine. If the write protect
switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware upgrade or application
merge.
1. Turn the main switch off.
2. Insert the original SD card in SD Card Slot 2. The application program is copied back into this card.
3. Insert the SD card (having stored the application program) to SD Card Slot 1. The application program 5
is copied back from this SD card.
4. Turn the main switch on.
5. Start the SP mode.
6. Select SP5-873-002 Undo Exec.
7. Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8. Turn the main switch off.
9. Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.
This step assumes that the application programs in the SD card are used by the machine.
10. Turn the main switch on.
11. Check that the application programs run normally.
549
5. System Maintenance
3. Press the Exit button. Then turn the copier off and on again.
550
NVRAM Data Upload/Download
This data should always be uploaded to an SD card before the NVRAM is replaced.
Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked
1. Do SP5990-001 (SMC Print) before you switch the machine off. You will need a record of the NVRAM
settings if the upload fails.
2. Switch the copier main power switch off.
3. Remove the SD slot cover (s x 1).
4. Insert the SD card into SD card slot 2. Then switch the copier on.
5
5. Execute SP5824-001 (NVRAM Data Upload) and then press the "Execute" key.
6. The following files are copied to an NVRAM folder on the SD card when the upload procedure is
finished. The file is saved to the path and the following filename:
NVRAM\<serial number>.NV
Here is an example with Serial Number "K5000017114":
NVRAM\K5000017114.NV
7. In order to prevent an error during the download, be sure to mark the SD card that holds the uploaded
data with the number of the machine from which the data was uploaded.
You can upload NVRAM data from more than one machine to the same SD card.
Do the following procedure to download SP data from an SD card to the NVRAM in the machine.
The NVRAM data download may fail if the SD card with the NVRAM data is damaged, or if the
connection between the controller and BCU is defective.
Do the download procedure again if the download fails.
Do the following procedure if the second attempt fails:
Enter the NVRAM data manually using the SMC print you created before uploading the NVRAM
data.
1. Switch the copier main power switch off.
551
5. System Maintenance
The serial number of the file on the SD card must match the serial number of the machine for the
NVRAM data to download successfully. The download fails if the serial numbers do not match.
This procedure does not download the following data to the NVRAM:
Total Count
C/O, P/O Count
552
Address Book Upload/Download
Information
Registration No.
Select Title
User Code
Folder
E-mail
Local Authentication
Protection Code
Folder Authentication
Fax Destination
Fax Option
Account ACL 5
New Document Initial ACL
Group Name
LDAP Authentication
Key Display
Download
If the capacity of SD card is not enough to store the local user information, an error message is
displayed.
Carefully handle the SD card, which contains user information. Do not take it back to your
location.
553
5. System Maintenance
Upload
554
Using the Debug Log
This machine provides a Save Debug Log feature that allows the Customer Engineer to save and retrieve
error information for analysis.
Every time an error occurs, debug information is recorded in volatile memory. But this information is lost
when the machine is switched off and on.
To capture this debug information, the Save Debug Log feature provides two main features:
Switching on the debug feature so error information is saved directly to the HDD for later retrieval.
Copying the error information from the HDD to an SD card.
Do the following procedure below to set up the machine so the error information is saved automatically to
the HDD when a user has problems with the machine. Then ask the user to reproduce the problem. 5
Switching ON and Setting UP Save Debug Log
The debug information cannot be saved until the "Save Debug Log" function has been switched on and a
target has been selected.
1. Enter the SP mode and switch the Save Debug Log feature on.
Enter "System SP".
On the LCD panel, open SP5857.
2. Under "5857 Save Debug Log", touch "1 On/Off".
3. On the control panel keypad, press "1". Then press . This switches the Save Debug Log feature on.
The default setting is "0" (OFF). This feature must be switched on in order for the debug information
to be saved.
555
5. System Maintenance
4. Select the target destination where the debug information will be saved. Under "5857 Save Debug
Log", touch "2 Target", enter "2" with the operation panel key to select the hard disk as the target
destination. Then press .
5 Select "3 SD Card" to save the debug information directly to the SD card if it is inserted in the
service slot.
5. Now touch "5858" and specify the events that you want to record in the debug log. SP5858 (Debug
Save When) provides the following items for selection.
556
Using the Debug Log
For details about SC code numbers, please refer to the SC tables in Section 4. "Troubleshooting".
6. Select one or more memory modules for reading and recording debug information. Touch "5859".
Under "5859" press the necessary key item for the module that you want to record.
Enter the appropriate 4-digit number. Then press .
Refer to the two tables below for the 4-digit numbers to enter for each key.
The example below shows "Key 1" with "2222" entered.
557
5. System Maintenance
The following keys can be set with the corresponding numbers. (The initials in parentheses indicate
the names of the modules.)
1 2222 (SCS)
2 14000 (SRM)
3 256 (IMH)
4 1000 (ECS)
5 1025 (MCS)
Key to Acronyms
Acronym Meaning Acronym Meaning
1. The machine is now set to record the debugging information automatically on the HDD (the target
selected with SP5857-002) for the events that you selected with SP5858 and the memory modules
selected with SP5859.
558
Using the Debug Log
Please keep the following important points in mind when you do this setting:
Note that the number entries for Keys 1 to 5 are the same for the Copy, Printer, Scanner, and Web
memory modules.
The initial settings are all zero.
These settings remain in effect until you change them. Be sure to check all the settings, especially the
settings for Keys 6 to 10. To switch off a key setting, enter a zero for that key.
You can select any number of keys from 1 to 10 (or all) by entering the corresponding 4-digit numbers
from the table.
You cannot mix settings for the groups (COPY, PRINTER, etc.) for 006 to 010. For example, if you
want to create a PRINTER debug log you must select the settings from the 9 available selections for
the "PRINTER" column only.
One area of the disk is reserved to store the debug log. The size of this area is limited to 4 MB.
SC errors and jams only are recorded to the debug log automatically. Please instruct the user to do the
following immediately after occurrence to save the debug data for any other errors that occur while the
customer engineer is not on site. Such problems also include a controller or panel freeze.
You must previously switch on the Save Debug Feature (SP5857-001) and select the hard disk as
the save destination (SP5857-002) if you want to use this feature.
1. Press (Clear Modes).on the operation panel when the error occurs.
2. On the control panel, enter "01". Then hold down for at least 3 seconds until the machine beeps
and then release it. This saves the debug log to the hard disk for later retrieval with an SD card by the
service representatives.
3. Switch the machine off and on to resume operation.
The debug information for the error is saved on the hard disk. This lets the service representative retrieve
it on their next visit by copying it from the HDD to an SD card.
559
5. System Maintenance
Card Save:
The Card Save function is used to save print jobs received by the printer on an SD card with no print
output. Card Save mode is toggled using printer Bit Switch #1 bit number 4. Card Save will remain
enabled until the SD card becomes full, or until all file names have been used.
Captures are stored on the SD card in the folder /prt/cardsave. File names are assigned sequentially
from PRT00000.prn to PRT99999.prn. An additional file PRT.CTL will be created. This file contains a
list of all files created on the card by the card save function.
5 Previously stored files on the SD card can be overwritten or left intact. Card Save SD has Add and
New menu items.
Card Save (Add): Appends files to the SD Card. Does not overwrite existing files. If the card
becomes full or if all file names are used, an error will be displayed on the operation panel.
Subsequent jobs will not be stored.
Card Save (New): Overwrites files in the card's /prt/cardsave directory.
Limitation:
Card Save cannot be used with PJL Status Readback commands. PJL Status Readbacks will not work.
In addition they will cause the Card Save to fail.
Procedure
560
Card Save Function
6. Select Bit Switch 1 Settings and use the numeric keypad to turn bit 4 ON and then press the #
button to register the change. The result should look like: 00010000. By doing this, Card Save option
will appear in the List/Test Print menu.
561
5. System Maintenance
10. Card Save (Add) and Card Save (New) should be displayed on the screen. Select Card Save (Add)
or Card Save (New).
14. Send a job to the printer. The Communicating light should start blinking as shown below.
562
Card Save Function
15. As soon as the printer receives the data, it will be stored on the SD card automatically with no print
output. Nothing is displayed on the screen, indicating that a Card Save operation was successful.
16. Press Offline and then the Clear/Stop button to exit Card Save mode.
17. Change the Bit Switch Settings back to the default 00000000. Press the # button in the numeric
keypad to register the changes.
18. Remove the SD card after the main power switch is turned off.
Error Messages
Card Save error messages:
Init error: A card save process (i.e. card detection, change to kernel mode) failed to initialize.
Card not found: Card cannot be detected in the slot.
No memory: Insufficient working memory to process the job.
Write error: Failed to write to the card.
Other error: An unknown error occurred.
If an error occurs, pressing OK will cause the device to discard the job and return to the ready state.
563
5. System Maintenance
564
6. Troubleshooting
SC Tables
Service Call Conditions
Summary
The SC Table section shows the SC codes for controller errors and other errors. The latter (not controller
errors) are put into four types. The type is determined by their reset procedures. The table shows the
classification of the SC codes.
After you turn the main power switch off, wait for one second or more before you turn the main power
switch on ( SC 672). All SCs are logged. The print log data (SP5-990-004) in SP mode can check the
latest 10 SC codes detected and total counters when the SC code is detected.
If the problem concerns electrical circuit boards, first disconnect then reconnect the connectors before
you replace the PCBs.
565
6. Troubleshooting
If the problem concerns a motor lock, first check the mechanical load before you replace motors or
sensors.
SC Code Classification
The table shows the classification of the SC codes:
100 - Scanner
1XX Scanning
190 - Unique for a specific model
240 - LD control
6
280 - Unique for a specific model
300 - Charge
430 - Cleaning
4XX Image development 2
440 - Around drum
460 - Unit
480 - Others
566
SC Tables
540 - Fusing
5XX Paper feed / Fusing
560 - Others
650 - Network
900 - Counter
990 - Others
567
6. Troubleshooting
SC1xx: Scanning
The peak white level is less than 64/255 digits (8 bits) when scanning the shading
plate.
The scanner home position sensor does not detect the OFF condition during
operation.
1. Check the cable connection between the BCU and scanner motor.
2. Check the cable connection between the BCU and HP sensor.
3. Replace the scanner motor.
4. Replace the scanner HP sensor.
568
SC Tables
The scanner home position sensor does not detect the ON condition during
operation.
1. Check the cable connection between the BCU board and scanner motor.
2. Check the cable connection between the BCU and HP sensor.
3. Replace the scanner motor.
4. Replace the scanner HP sensor.
6
No. Type Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
The black level cannot be adjusted within the target value during the zero clamp.
Harness disconnected
141 D
Defective SBU
569
6. Troubleshooting
The white level cannot be adjusted within the target during auto gain control.
The SBU connection cannot be detected at power on or recovery from the energy
save mode.
Defective SBU
144 D Defective harness
Defective detection port on the BCU
570
SC Tables
The copy data security board is not detected when the copy data security
function is set "ON" with the initial setting.
A device check error occurs when the copy data security function is set "ON"
with the initial setting.
165 D
Incorrect installation of the copy data security board
Defective copy data security board
571
6. Troubleshooting
Serial number stored in the memory does not have the correct code.
NVRAM defective
195 D BCU replaced without original NVRAM
SC 2xx: Exposure
The polygon mirror motor does not reach the targeted operating speed within the
specified time after turning on or changing speed
572
SC Tables
The polygon mirror motor does leave the READY status within 3 seconds after the
polygon motor switches off.
573
6. Troubleshooting
The laser synchronizing detection signal for the start position of the LDB [K], [Y], is
not output for two seconds after LDB unit turns on while the polygon motor is rotating
normally.
FGATE ON error: K
The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for start position [K].
Defective ASIC
230 D Poor connection between IPU and BCU.
Defective BCU
1. Check the connection between the controller board and the BCU.
2. Replace the BCU.
3. Replace the controller board.
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
231 D in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for end position [K].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
574
SC Tables
FGATE ON error: Y
The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image
232 D
in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for start position [Y].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
233 D in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for end position [Y].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image
234 D
in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for start position [M].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
235 D in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for end position [M].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
575
6. Troubleshooting
FGATE ON error: C
The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image
236 D
in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for start position [C].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
237 D in normal job or MUSIC (line position adjustment) for end position [C].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
240 C LD error: K
241 C LD error: Y
The BCU detects LDB error a few times consecutively when LDB unit turns on after
LDB initialization.
Worn-out LD
- - Disconnected or broken harness of the LD
576
SC Tables
1. Check and reinstall the image transfer belt unit and PCDU(s).
2. Check if each toner bottle has enough toner.
3. Replace the ID sensor.
4. Replace the image transfer belt unit.
5. Replace the PCDU(s).
6. Replace the laser unit.
6
The measured voltage is not proper when BCU measures the charge output for each
color.
577
6. Troubleshooting
The motor LOCK signal is not detected for more than two seconds while the motor
START signal is on.
The Vt value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor exceeds the
specified value (default: 4.7V) with SP3020-002 twenty counts.
The [Vt - Vtref] value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor exceeds
the specified value (default: 5.0V) with SP3020-001.
1. Check the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor connector and harness
between the TD sensor and development unit for damage.
2. Check the drawer connector of the PCDU.
3. Replace the development unit.
4. Replace the PCDU.
578
SC Tables
The Vt value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor is below the specified
value with SP3020-004 (default: 0.5V) ten counts.
579
6. Troubleshooting
The machine does not detect a change signal (H L or L H) for 2.4 seconds at
the drum phase adjustment.
580
SC Tables
The machine detects a High signal from the drum/development motor: K for 2
seconds after the drum/development motor: K turned on.
6
No. Type Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
The machine detects a High signal from the drum motor: CMY for 2 seconds after
the drum motor: CMY turned on.
581
6. Troubleshooting
When the Vsg error counter reaches "3", the machine detects "SC400".
400 D
The Vsg error counter counts "1" when the Vsg detected by ID sensor is more than
the value (default: 4.5V) specified with SP3324-005 or less than the value (default:
3.5V) specified with SP3324-006.
582
SC Tables
The motor LOCK signal is not detected for more than two seconds while the motor
START signal is on.
Motor overload
Defective ITB unit motor
Defective or disconnected connector
441 D
Check the operation of the ITB unit motor with SP5804-051.
No operation:
1. Check the harness of the ITB unit motor.
2. Check if the cleaning blade of the ITB cleaning unit is rolled up.
3. Replace the ITB unit motor.
4. Replace the ITB unit.
6
No. Type Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
The ITB contact sensor does not detect the movement of actuator at the sensor while
the polygon motor rotates.
583
6. Troubleshooting
The PTR contact sensor does not detect the movement of actuator at the sensor while
the polygon motor rotates.
584
SC Tables
An error signal is detected for 0.2 seconds when charging the drum or development.
High voltage power: Image transfer/ paper transfer bias output error 6
An error signal is detected for 0.2 seconds when charging the separation, image
transfer belt or paper transfer roller.
585
6. Troubleshooting
The machine detects that the PCDU toner collection bottle is not set for one second
when the PCDU toner collection motor is turned off.
503 B 3rd paper tray lift motor malfunction (optional Paper Tray Unit)
504 B 4th paper tray lift motor malfunction (optional Paper Tray Unit)
The paper lift sensor did not activate within 18 sec. (for PTU) or 8 sec. (for LCT) after
the tray lift motor switched on.
An obstruction (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) has blocked the motor drive
and caused an overload.
Paper lift sensor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged
586
SC Tables
A motor lock signal is not detected for more than 1.5 s at power-on or the lock signal
is not detected for more than 1.0 s during rotation.
An obstruction (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.) has blocked the feed motor
drive and caused an overload.
506 B
Paper tray feed motor connection loose, disconnected, or damaged
Paper tray feed motor defective
587
6. Troubleshooting
The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal
was first detected.
588
SC Tables
The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal
was first detected.
The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal
was first detected.
589
6. Troubleshooting
The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal
was first detected.
The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal
was first detected.
590
SC Tables
The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal
was first detected.
Motor overload
540 D
Defective fusing/paper exit motor
Defective or disconnected connection for the fusing/paper exit motor
The temperature detected by the thermopile does not reach 0C for 3 seconds.
591
6. Troubleshooting
The heating roller temperature does not reach 50C for 4 seconds after the
heating lamp on.
542 A The heating roller temperature does not reach the ready temperature for 43
seconds after the fusing unit has rotated.
The heating roller temperature does not reach 100C for 24 seconds in the
low temperature condition after the heating lamp on.
Defective PSU
543 A
Defective BCU
592
SC Tables
During stand-by mode or a print job, the detected heating roller temperature reaches
250C.
Defective PSU
544 A
Defective BCU
Defective fusing control system
When the fusing unit is not running in the ready condition, the heating roller fusing 6
lamp keeps on full power for 37 seconds.
593
6. Troubleshooting
The zero cross signal is detected for 0.05 seconds three times even though the
heater relay is off when turning on the main power.
The zero cross signal is not detected for 2 seconds even though the heater relay
is on after turning on the main power or closing the front door.
The detection error occurs twice or more in the 11 zero cross signal detections.
This error is defined when the detected zero cross signal is less than 45.
547 D
Defective fusing lamp relay
Defective fusing lamp relay circuit
Unstable power supply
The temperature measured by the heating roller thermistor (end) does not reach
0C for 150 seconds when the machine's inside temperature is 5C or more.
The temperature measured by the heating roller thermistor (end) is -5C or less
for 8 seconds.
551 A
Loose connection of heating roller thermistor (end)
Defective heating roller thermistor (end)
594
SC Tables
The heating roller temperature does not reach the ready temperature for 65
seconds after the fusing unit has rotated.
The heating roller temperature does not reach 100C for 25 seconds in the
low temperature condition after the heating lamp on.
The detected pressure roller temperature stays at 230C or more for 1 second.
Defective PSU
553 A
Defective BCU
Defective PSU
554 A Defective BCU
Defective fusing control system
595
6. Troubleshooting
When the fusing unit is not running in the ready condition, the pressure roller-fusing
lamp keeps ON full power for 130 seconds or more.
When the zero cross signal is 66 or more and it is detected 10 times or more in 11
6 557 C detections, the machine determines that input 60 Hz and SC557 occurs.
The paper jam counter for the fusing unit reaches 3 times. The paper jam counter is
cleared if the paper is fed correctly.
559 A This SC is activated only when SP1142-001 is set to "1" (default "0").
Remove the paper that is jammed in the fusing unit. Then make sure that the fusing
unit is clean and has no obstacles in the paper feed path.
596
SC Tables
The temperature measured by the pressure roller thermistor (center) does not reach
0C for 45 seconds.
The detected fusing roller temperature stays at 230C or more for 1 second.
563 A
Defective PSU 6
Defective BCU
Defective PSU
564 A Defective BCU
Defective fusing control system
597
6. Troubleshooting
The temperature measured by the pressure roller thermistor (end) does not reach 0
C for 45 seconds.
The detected pressure roller temperature stays at 230C or more for 1 second.
6 573 A
Defective PSU
Defective BCU
Defective PSU
574 A Defective BCU
Defective fusing control system
598
SC Tables
After the ARDF is detected, the break signal occurs or communication timeout occurs.
599
6. Troubleshooting
While the BCU communicates with an optional unit, an SC code is displayed if one
of following conditions occurs.
The BCU receives the break signal which is generated by the peripherals only
just after the main switch is turned on.
When the BCU does not receive an OK signal from a peripheral 100ms after
sending a command to it. The BCU resends the command. The BCU does not
receive an OK signal after sending the command 3 times.
Cable problems
BCU problems
- -
PSU problems in the machine
Main board problems in the peripherals
Defective main board of peripherals.
Disconnected peripherals.
6 1. Check if the cables of peripherals are correctly connected.
2. Replace the PSU if no power is supplied to peripherals.
3. Replace the main board of peripherals.
4. Replace the BCU.
After 3 attempts to send a data frame to the optional counter device via the serial
CTL communication line, no ACK signal was received within 100 ms.
632
B
Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board and copier
control board is disconnected or damaged
Make sure that SP5113 is set to enable the optional counter device.
600
SC Tables
After 3 attempts to send a data frame to the optional counter device via the serial
CTL communication line, no ACK signal was received within 100 ms.
633
B
Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board and copier
control board is disconnected or damaged
Make sure that SP5113 is set to enable the optional counter device.
601
6. Troubleshooting
Version error
A sampling of the control data sent from the BCU reveals an abnormality.
CTL
650 Communication error of the remote service modem (RCG-M)
B
602
SC Tables
Authentication error
Incorrect SP settings
-001 - Disconnected telephone line
Disconnected modem board
Disconnected Local Area Network card
Check and set the correct user name (SP5816-156) and password (SP5816-157).
The supplied voltage is not sufficient due to the defective communication line or
-005 - defective connection.
Same as -001
No action required because this SC does not interfere with operation of the machine.
603
6. Troubleshooting
NVRAM error
Retry of NVRAM communication fails three times after the machine has detected the
669 D NVRAM error.
Caused by noise
CTL The ready signal from the engine board is not detected.
670
D Defective engine board.
604
SC Tables
After powering on the machine, the communication circuit between the controller
and the operation panel is not opened, or communication with controller is
interrupted after a normal startup.
Noise
No memory chip on the toner cartridge
001-005 Defective RFID reader and writer
Disconnected RFID controller board I/F
Retry of RFID communication fails three times after the machine has detected the
RFID communication error.
605
6. Troubleshooting
Retry of memory chip communication fails three times after the machine has detected
the memory chip communication error.
The machine gets RFID communication error even the toner cartridges have not been
683 C installed in the machine.
Caused by noise
606
SC Tables
The BCU does not receive a memory address command from the controller for the
prescribed time after the paper has reached the registration sensor.
Loose connection
690 D
Defective BCU
Defective LD controller board
607
6. Troubleshooting
SC7xx: Peripherals
The shift tray HP sensor does not activate within 1.86 seconds after the shift tray
motor starts to move at power on or copying. The 1st detection failure issues a jam
error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.
730 B
Defective shift tray motor
Defective shift tray HP sensor.
Staple jam
Motor overload
740 D Defective stapler motor
Defective stapler safety sensor
1. Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.
2. Replace the stapler unit
3. Replace the finisher main board.
608
SC Tables
Motor overload
Loose connection of the stapler unit HP sensor
Loose connection of the stapler unit movement motor
Defective stapler unit HP sensor
742 D
Defective stapler movement motor
609
6. Troubleshooting
The punch HP sensor is not activated within the specified time after the punch motor
turned on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this
SC code.
1. Check the connections and cables for the punch motor and HP sensor.
2. Check for blockages in the punch motor mechanism.
3. Replace the punch slider unit.
4. Replace the punch unit.
5. Replace the finisher main board.
6
No. Type Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)
The punch unit moves but is not detected at the home position within the specified
time. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC
code.
610
SC Tables
The machine does not detect correct voltage from the paper edge detection sensor.
Defective connector
787 D Defective paper edge detection sensor.
Defective DA or AD converter.
The machine does not detect correct voltage from the paper size sensors.
6
Defective connector
Defective paper size sensors
Defective DA or AD converter.
611
6. Troubleshooting
The machine does not detect a correct signal from the front jogger fence HP sensor
at power-on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues
this SC code.
The machine does not detect a correct signal from the rear jogger fence HP sensor
at power-on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues
this SC code.
612
SC Tables
The machine does not detect a correct signal from the pick-up roller HP sensor at
power-on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this
SC code.
Disconnected harness
6
Defective belt roller position sensor
796 B Defective belt roller solenoid
613
6. Troubleshooting
The machine detects the fan lock signal (ON) consecutively 200 ms.
614
SC Tables
Monitor Error
This is a file detection and electronic file signature check error when the boot loader
attempts to read the self-diagnostic module, system kernel, or root system files from
CTL
817 the OS Flash ROM, or the items on the SD card in the controller slot are false or
D corrupted.
CPU error
During the self-diagnostic, the controller CPU detects an error. There are 47 types
of error code (0001 to 4005) depending on the cause of the error. The CPU detects
[0001] to [06FF] an error and displays the specific error code with the program address where the
[0801] to [4005] error occurs.
615
6. Troubleshooting
CPU/Memory Error
ASIC error
616
SC Tables
The CPU checks if the ASIC timer works correctly compared with the CPU timer. If
the ASIC timer does not function in the specified range, this SC code is displayed.
The CPU detects the video bridge device, but detects error data from the video
[50A2] bridge device.
When the main switch is turned on or starting the self-diagnostic, the HDD stays busy
- -
for the specified time or more.
617
6. Troubleshooting
Loose connection
- - Defective HDD
Defective controller
PHY IC error
[6104]
The PHY IC on the controller cannot be correctly recognized.
618
SC Tables
[1401]
Self-diagnosis error: Standard NVRAM
The controller cannot recognize the standard NVRAM installed or detects that the
NVRAM is defective.
CTL 6
826 Self-diagnostic Error: RTC/optional NVRAM
D
The one second counted by the RTC is different from the one second counted by the
CPU on the controller.
[1501]
Defective the RTC device
619
6. Troubleshooting
Verification error
Error detected during a write/verify check for the standard RAM (SDRAM DIMM).
Loose connection
Defective SDRAM DIMM
[0201]
Defective controller
620
SC Tables
CTL
833 Self-diagnostic error 8: Engine I/F ASIC
C
ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI
[0F30] configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked.
[0F31]
Replace the BCU.
ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI 6
[0F41] configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked.
CTL
838 Self-diagnostic Error: Clock Generator
D
621
6. Troubleshooting
A verify error occurred when setting data is read from the clock generator on the
controller.
CTL
839 USB NAND Flash ROM error
C
Defective IEEE1394
CTL
851 Defective controller.
B
1. Turn the main switch off and on.
2. Replace the IEEE1394 interface board.
3. Replace the controller.
622
SC Tables
The wireless LAN card is not detected before communication is established, though
CTL the wireless LAN board is detected.
853
B
Loose connection
623
6. Troubleshooting
A serious error occurs when data is encrypted to update an encryption key with the
HDD encryption unit.
6 858
C NVRAM data encryption error 1:
An error occurs while the NVRAM data is encrypted.
[2]
Defective NVRAM on the controller board
1. Replace the NVRAM.
Other error:
Same as SC991
624
SC Tables
A serious error occurs when the HDD data is encrypted to update an encryption key
with the HDD encryption unit.
No HDD installed
Same as SC863
625
6. Troubleshooting
The HDD does not become ready within 30 seconds after the power is supplied to
the HDD.
Loose connection
Defective cables
CTL
861 Defective HDD
D
Defective controller
The number of bad sectors in the HDD (image data area) goes over 101.
CTL
862 Defective HDD
D
1. Format the HDD with SP5-832-002.
2. Replace the HDD.
626
SC Tables
While reading data from the HDD or storing data in the HDD, data transmission
CTL fails.
864
D
Defective HDD
SD card error
627
6. Troubleshooting
An error is detected in the data copied to the address book over a network.
628
SC Tables
Defective HDD
CTL
872 Power failure during an access to the HDD
B
1. Turn the main switch off and on.
2. Initialize the HDD partition (SP5-832-007).
3. Replace the HDD.
An error is detected while all of the HDD or NVRAM are formatted physically by
the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362).
CTL
874 DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (SD card) not installed
D
Defective HDD
629
6. Troubleshooting
An error is detected while all of the HDD or NVRAM are formatted logically by the
CTL DataOverwriteSecurity Unit (D362).
875
D
The logical format for the HDD fails.
Turn the main switch off/on and try the operation again
630
SC Tables
The 'all delete' function cannot be executed but the DataOverwriteSecurity Unit
(D362) is installed and activated.
6
CTL
877 Defective SD card (D362)
D
SD card (D362) not installed
1. Replace the NVRAM and then install the new SD card (D362).
2. Check and reinstall the SD card (D362).
631
6. Troubleshooting
SC9xx: Miscellaneous
6 900
CTL
Defective NVRAM
Defective controller
D
1. Check the connection between the NVRAM and controller.
2. Replace the NVRAM.
3. Replace the controller.
632
SC Tables
Defective software
Defective controller
990
CTL
Software error
6
D
1. Turn the main switch off and on.
2. Reinstall the controller and/or engine main firmware.
633
6. Troubleshooting
Undefined error
Defective BCU
6 -001 1. Input the serial number with SP5811-004, and turn the main power switch off/
on.
-002 1. Install a new NVRAM, and turn off and on the main power switch after
SC995-002 has occurred.
2. Reinstall the previous NVRAM or download the information with SP5825-001,
after that turn the main power off and on.
634
SC Tables
Note 1
If a problem always occurs in a specific condition (for example. printer driver setting, image file), the
problem may be caused by a software error. In this case, the following data and information needs to be
sent back to your product specialist. Please understand that it may take some time to get a reply on how
to solve the problem, because in some cases the design staff in Japan must analyze the data.
Symptom / Possible Causes / Action taken
Summary sheet (SP mode Printer SP, SP1-004 [Print Summary])
635
6. Troubleshooting
636
Process Control Error Conditions
1. Defective TD sensor
Vcnt is Vt target over
9 Vcnt error 3 2. Vt target settings are not correct.
0.2V.
3. Toner density error
The machine starts developer initialization after you set 1 in SP3-902-005, 006, 007, or 008.
Developer initialization automatically resumes when you open and close the front door or turn the
main switch off and on if an error other than Error 8 occurs.
637
6. Troubleshooting
638
Process Control Error Conditions
58
Vk error:
Minimum
Vk is out of range.
Vk < 300
Background dirty
Hardware defective
6
Same as 53
Vsg adjustment is
1 O.K -
correctly done.
639
6. Troubleshooting
640
Process Control Error Conditions
Completed
1 Line position adjustment has correctly been done, -
successfully
Cannot detect ID sensors have not detected the patterns for line position
2 See Note
patterns adjustment.
For details, see the "Troubleshooting Guide - Line Position Adjustment" section. 6
641
6. Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting Guide
Image Quality
The following work-flow shows the basic troubleshooting steps for the image quality problems on this
product.
642
Troubleshooting Guide
643
6. Troubleshooting
When there are color registration errors on the output, do the line position adjustment as follows.
Test
1. Do SP2-111-003 (Mode c: rough adjustment).
2. Use SP2-194-007 to check if the result of the line position adjustment is correct (0: Completed
successfully, 1: Not completed). If the result is "1", refer to Countermeasure list for color registration
errors.
3. Do SP2-111-001 (Mode a: fine adjustment twice).
4. Use SP2-194-007 to check if the result of the line position adjustment is correct (0: Completed
successfully, 1: Not completed). If the result is "1", refer to Countermeasure list for color registration
errors.
6 5. Put some A3/DLT paper on the by-pass tray.
When you print a test pattern, use the by-pass tray to feed the paper.
6. Print out test pattern "7" with SP2-109-003.
7. Check the printed output with a loupe.
8. If there are no color registration errors on the output, the line position adjustment is correctly done. If
not, refer to the countermeasure list for color registration errors.
644
Troubleshooting Guide
Defective ID sensors
Normal image, but with color Defective BCU
registration errors 1. Replace the ID sensor.
2. Replace the BCU.
645
6. Troubleshooting
Defective PCU
Defective laser unit
The skew for M, C, Y is more than Defective BCU
0.75 mm from the main scan
registration of K 1. Reinstall or replace the BCU.
2. Replace the laser unit.
3. Replace the BCU.
6 Skew correction upper limit error
Defective BCU
Others Defective laser unit
1. Replace the BCU.
2. Replace the laser unit.
Do SP2-111-001 or -002.
646
Troubleshooting Guide
647
6. Troubleshooting
648
Troubleshooting Guide
The main scan length of K is shifted. Abnormal SP setting value of main scan length detection:
K
Adjust the value with SP2-102-001 and -003.
Note:
The setting value of these SPs should be same.
649
6. Troubleshooting
If a defect occurs in the image at one of these intervals, the related component may be defective.
650
Troubleshooting Guide
Development roller: 32 mm
PTR (Paper Transfer Roller): 75.0 mm
Drum: 94.2 mm
Fusing belt: 157.1 mm
Input the same value in these SP settings. Otherwise, color registration errors occur on outputs
and this cannot be recovered by the line position adjustment.
SP1-803-001: Plain paper/ 600 dpi Input
SP1-803-002: Plain paper/ 1200 dpi Input
SP1-803-003: Thick paper Input
2. Turn the main power of the machine off and on.
3. Check if all settings of the following SPs are "0" (success).
SP1-803-004: Plain paper/ 600 dpi Result
SP1-803-005: Plain paper/ 1200 dpi Result
SP1-803-006: Thick paper Result
651
6. Troubleshooting
If one of the settings of SP1-803-004 to 006 is "1" (error), return to step 1 and then input a value
which is closer to "0" compared with the previously input value.
For example, if "+0.9" is input in the settings of SP1-803-001 to 003 and an error occurs, input
"+0.8" or less with SP1-803-001 to 003.
For example, if "-0.9" is input in the settings of SP1-803-001 to 003 and an error occurs, input
"-0.8" or more with SP1-803-001 to 003.
If an error still remains, refer to "Motor Speed Adjustment".
4. Execute the line position adjustment (rough) with SP2-111-003.
5. Execute the line position adjustment (fine) with SP2-111-001.
6. Make sample copies and check if the outputs are satisfactory.
6 setting of the motor speed adjustment may be out of adjustable range. Check the following three points.
1. An error ("1") occurs in SP1-803-004.
[Setting values of the following SPs + input value with SP1-803-001] > motor speed adjustable range
e.g.) 3.5 (SP1-801-002) + 1 (SP1-803-001 to -003) = 4.5
In this case, "4.5" is over the maximum adjustable value ("4") of the SP1-801-002. As a result, the
result of the motor speed adjustment issues "1" (error).
Adjust the settings of the SP1-830-001 to -003 so that the total value (motor speed setting value
+ input value) is within the adjustable range for each motor described below.
652
Troubleshooting Guide
SP1-801-034 2 -2 Feed1:CW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-035 2 -2 Feed1:CCW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-036 2 -2 Feed2:CW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-037 2 -2 Feed2:CCW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-038 2 -2 By-pass:60:1200dpi
SP1-801-039 2 -2 Inverter:CW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-040 2 -2 Inverter:CCW60:1200dpi
SP1-801-041 6 -6 FusingMot:60:1200dpi
SP1-801-042 4 -4 BkOpcDevMot:60:1200dpi
SP1-801-043 4 -4 TransferMot:60:1200dpi
653
6. Troubleshooting
SP1-801-004 4 -4 Bk OpcDevMot:60:Thick
SP1-801-010 4 -4 TransferMot:60:Thick
6 SP1-801-011 2 -2 Feed1:CW60:Thick
SP1-801-013 2 -2 Feed1:CCW60:Thick
SP1-801-015 2 -2 Feed2:CW60:Thick
SP1-801-017 2 -2 Feed2:CCW60:Thick
SP1-801-019 2 -2 By-pass:60:Thick
SP1-801-021 2 -2 Inverter:CW60:Thick
SP1-801-023 2 -2 Inverter:CCW60:Thick
654
Troubleshooting Guide
655
6. Troubleshooting
This screw is not necessary after tightening the front fusing guide.
656
Troubleshooting Guide
5. If the horizontal lines slope down to the left [A], move the front fusing guide upward. To do this, turn
the adjustor lever [B] of the fusing front guide clockwise [C].
One step of the adjustor lever moves the front fusing guide by 1 mm.
6. If the horizontal lines slope down to the right [A], move the fusing front guide downward. To do this,
turn the adjustor lever [B] of the front fusing guide counterclockwise [C].
One step of the adjustor lever moves the front fusing guide by 1 mm.
7. Retighten the four screws for the front fusing guide.
8. Print out the test pattern and check the image quality.
9. If the symptom still occurs, repeat the above steps.
Symptom:
657
6. Troubleshooting
A loud squeaking noise can be heard when two of the following conditions are met:
High image coverage
High original-to-copy ratio (1-to-x)
Printing at half speed
Cause:
Normally, silica inside the toner is deposited on the drum surface over a long period of time, some of which
is removed by the cleaning blade. However, when two or more of the conditions above are met, the rate
of deposit accelerates, and eventually the blade cannot run across the drum surface smoothly.
Solution:
If this problem is reported, replace the standard spring with the modified spring (P/N AA063690).
Side Effect:
The part life of the PCU may be shortened.
Replacement Procedure
2. Slide the upper cover [A] of the drum unit as shown and remove it.
658
Troubleshooting Guide
3. Carefully lift up the metal plate [A], and then remove the spring [B] at the front side and rear side.
4. Attach the modified spring [A] to the boss [B] on the lubricant holder.
5. Install the metal plate [C] in the spring [A] so that the modified spring is kept between the boss [B] on
the lubricant holder and the metal plate.
659
6. Troubleshooting
Symptom:
A loud vibration can be heard while the paper is being fed from the paper tray.
Cause:
The excessive pressure between the feed roller and friction pad of the paper tray causes a loud vibration
due to the incorrect position of the maylar at the friction pad.
Solution:
6 Reinstall the friction pad in the correct position. For details, see "Friction Pad" in the section "Replacement
and Adjustment".
Grainy Image
If grainy images are reported from the field, use the following flowchart to take action in response to the
eight conditions.
660
Troubleshooting Guide
661
6. Troubleshooting
Action Procedure
1. If the grainy images only appear in black image areas with Printer Full Color mode, select "CMY
+K" with the PCL printer driver. For details, see "Action 1" described below.
2. Change the paper transfer bias. For details, see "Action 2A" described below.
3. Increase the amount of the toner per area (M/A). For details, see "Action 3" described below.
4. Ask a customer to change paper from high resistant paper to more smooth paper.
Action Procedure
1. Ask a customer to keep paper in dry condition.
2. Turn on the tray heater if it has already been installed or ask a customer to install the optional tray
heater.
6 3. If the grainy images only appear in black image areas with Printer Full Color mode, select "CMY
+K" with the PCL printer driver. For details, see "Action 1" described below.
4. Change the paper transfer bias. For details, see "Action 2A" described below.
5. Increase the amount of the toner per area (M/A). For details, see "Action 3" described below.
Action Procedure
1. If the grainy images only appear in black image areas with Printer Full Color mode, select "CMY
+K" with the PCL printer driver. For details, see "Action 1" described below.
2. Change the paper transfer bias. For details, see "Action 2B" described below.
3. Increase the amount of the toner per area (M/A). For details, see "Action 3" described below.
4. Ask a customer to change paper from rough surface paper to more smooth paper.
662
Troubleshooting Guide
Action Procedure
1. If the grainy images only appear in black image areas with Printer Full Color mode, select "CMY
+K" with the PCL printer driver. For details, see "Action 1" described below.
2. Use the A4 LEF paper. If A4 LEF paper does not solve the grainy image, check the other causes
(Cause 1, 2 and 3)
3. Change the paper size correction coefficient. For details, see "Action 4" described below.
4. Increase the amount of the toner per area (M/A). For details, see "Action 3" described below.
5. Ask a customer to change paper from high resistant paper to more smooth paper.
Action Procedure
1. Leave a machine for several hours if this symptom appears just after initial machine installation.
6
2. If the grainy images only appear in black image areas with Printer Full Color mode, select "CMY
+K" with the PCL printer driver. For details, see "Action 1" described below.
3. Decrease the target development gamma. For details, see "Action 5" described below.
4. Decrease the image transfer roller current for black and paper transfer roller current. For details,
see "Action 6" described below.
Action Procedure
1. Change the feeding direction from SEF to LEF.
2. Change the paper size correction coefficient. For details, see "Action 4" described below.
Action Procedure
Change the environmental correction table of the paper transfer roller for OHP. For details, see
"Action 8" described below.
663
6. Troubleshooting
Action Procedure
Select "CMY+K" with the PCL printer driver. For details, see "Action 1" described below.
Action List
Action 1
With this setting for PCL, all BW images are printed using process black, including text.
Action Procedure
6 Select "CMY+K" with the PCL printer driver. (Print Quality -> Color: Manual -> Gray reproduction ->
CMY+K)
Action 2A
Changing the PTR current for each paper type can solve the grainy image for the 1st side of paper.
Action Procedure
1. Increase the PTR current for the 1st side of paper in steps of 2 A until +6 A from the default value.
B/W mode/ Normal speed: SP2-403-001
B/W mode/ Low speed: SP2-403-003
Full Color mode/ Normal speed: SP2-407-001
Full Color mode/ Low speed: SP2-407-003
2. If the grainy images get worse, decrease the PTR current in steps of 2 A until -6 A from the default
value.
3. If the grainy images only occur when using a specific type of paper, set the Paper Type setting to one
of the Special Paper settings as follows.
- If the current Paper Type setting is one of the following, change it to Special Paper 1.
Plain Paper 1, Plain Paper 2, Middle Thick, Thin Paper, Coated Paper: Gloss
Select Special Paper 1, then adjust the settings of the following SP modes:
B/W mode/ Normal speed: SP2-753-001
B/W mode/ Low speed: SP2-753-003
664
Troubleshooting Guide
Action 2B
Changing the PTR current for each paper type can solve the grainy image for the 2nd side of paper.
Action Procedure
1. Increase the PTR current for the 2nd side of paper in steps of 2 A until +6 A from the default value.
B/W mode/ Normal speed: SP2-403-002
B/W mode/ Low speed: SP2-403-004
6
Full Color mode/ Normal speed: SP2-407-002
Full Color mode/ Low speed: SP2-407-004
2. If the grainy images get worse, decrease the PTR current in steps of 2 A until -6 A from the default
value.
3. If the grainy images only occur when using a specific type of paper, set the Paper Type setting to one
of the Special Paper settings as follows.
- If the current Paper Type setting is one of the following, change it to Special Paper 1.
Plain Paper 1, Plain Paper 2, Middle Thick, Thin Paper, Coated Paper: Gloss
Select Special Paper 1, then adjust the settings of the following SP modes:
B/W mode/ Normal speed: SP2-753-002
B/W mode/ Low speed: SP2-753-004
Full Color mode/ Normal speed: SP2-757-002
Full Color mode/ Low speed: SP2-757-004
- If the current Paper Type setting is one of the following, change it to Special Paper 4.
Thick Paper 1, Thick Paper 2, Thick Paper 3
Select Special Paper 4, then adjust the settings of the following SP modes:
B/W mode: SP2-783-001
Full Color mode: SP2-787-001
665
6. Troubleshooting
Basically, there are different setting values for 1st side and 2nd side of thick paper when using the
by-pass printing mode. When using thick paper in the by-pass printing mode, adjust the PTR current
of Special Paper 4 for the 2nd side of thick paper. Always use the adjusted setting of Special Paper
4 when the 2nd side of thick paper is fed from the by-pass tray.
Action 3
Increase the amount of the toner per area (M/A). However, too much toner may cause the toner blasting.
Action Procedure
1. Set the following SP modes to the values highlighted in bold.
Set the setting of SP3-501-001 to 0.500 mg/cm2 for Maximum M/A: Bk.
Set the setting of SP3-501-002 to 0.495 mg/cm2 for Maximum M/A: C.
Set the setting of SP3-501-003 to 0.495 mg/cm2 for Maximum M/A: M.
Set the setting of SP3-501-004 to 0.495 mg/cm2 for Maximum M/A: Y.
6 2. Execute Process Control with SP3-011-001.
Action 4
Changing the correction value of the PTR current for each paper size can solve the grainy image.
The paper size correction coefficient setting for non-special paper types is applied to several different
paper types at once. This can create side effects for paper types on which the symptom is not occurring.
Therefore, if you only want to change the setting for one type, use the Special Paper settings.
Action Procedure
1. Increase the correction value of the PTR current for each paper size in steps of 10% against the default
setting for each SP mode until +30% against the default setting of each SP mode.
- If the current Paper Type setting is one of the following, change it to Special Paper 1, 2 or 3.
Plain Paper 1, Plain Paper 2, Middle Thick, Thin Paper, Coated Paper: Gloss
Select Special Paper 1, 2 or 3, then adjust the settings of the following SP modes:
B/W mode for Plain Paper: SP2-411-001 to -020
Full Color mode for Plain Paper: SP2-412-001 to -020
- If the current Paper Type setting is one of the following, change it to Special Paper 4, 5 or 6.
Thick Paper 1, Thick Paper 2, Thick Paper 3
Select Special Paper 4, 5 or 6, then adjust the settings of the following SP modes:
B/W mode for Thick Paper: SP2-511-001 to -017
Full Color mode for Thick Paper: SP2-512-001 to -017.
666
Troubleshooting Guide
2. If the grainy images get worse, decrease the correction value of the PTR current for each paper size
in steps of -10% against the default setting for each SP mode until -30% against the default setting of
each SP mode.
If the special paper setting which is proper for this action procedure has already been used for the other
paper setting, change the following SPs of non-special paper types.
B/W mode for Special 1, 2 and 3: SP2-761-005 to -020
Full Color mode for Special 1, 2 and 3: SP2-762-005 to -020
B/W mode for Special 4, 5 and 6: SP2-791-005 to -020
Full Color mode for Special 4, 5 and 6: SP2-792-005 to -020
Action 5
Decreasing the target gamma for the developer can solve the grainy image.
Action Procedure
1. Change the setting of SP3-611-009 from "0.90" to "0.85".
2. Execute the SP3-011-001. 6
Action 6
Decreasing the transfer current values for the ITB roller and PTR can solve the grainy image in the BW
printing mode. However, decreasing the transfer current of the ITB roller affects other settings (paper
type and size) and may cause a light toner image for some paper type and size.
Action Procedure
Change the settings of SP2-351-001 by -2 A or SP2-351-003 by -1 A.
1. Decrease the transfer current of the PTR for each paper type by 1 A until -4 A from the default
setting.
B/W mode/ Normal or low speed for Plain Paper: SP2-403-001 to -004
B/W mode/ Normal or low speed for Thin Paper: SP2-453-001 and -003
B/W mode/ Low speed for Glossy Paper: SP2-482-001
B/W mode/ Low speed for Thick 1: SP2-502-001
B/W mode/ Low speed for Thick 2: SP 2-553-001
B/W mode/ Low speed for OHP: SP 2-603-001
B/W mode/ Low speed for Thick 3: SP 2-651-001
B/W mode/ Normal or low speed for Middle Thick Paper: SP2-703-001 to -004
B/W mode/ Normal or low speed for Special 1 Paper: SP2-753-001 to -004
B/W mode/ Normal or low speed for Special 2 Paper: SP2-803-001 to -004
667
6. Troubleshooting
B/W mode/ Normal or low speed for Special 3 Paper: SP2-852-001 to -004
B/W mode/ Low speed for Special 4 Paper: SP2-783-001
B/W mode/ Low speed for Special 5 Paper: SP2-833-001
B/W mode/ Low speed for Special 6 Paper: SP2-883-001
If the result of step 2 is not satisfactory, change the settings of SP2-351-001 by -2 A or SP2-351-003
by -1 A again and then decrease the transfer current of the PTR for each paper type by 1 A until
-4 A from the default setting again.
Action 7
Increasing the transfer current for the PTR can solve the grainy image on small size paper. Use Special
4, Special 5 or Special 6 for the small size paper setting. It is because the adjusted transfer current for
small size paper is very different from the transfer current for normal paper.
Action Procedure
1. Increase the settings of the PTR transfer current corrections for each paper size until a grainy image
on small size paper is solved.
6 B/W mode: SP2-791-005 to -017
Full color mode: SP2-791-005 to -017
Action 8
Increasing the transfer current for the PTR can solve the grainy image on OHP in the full color printing.
Action Procedure
1. Change the setting of SP2-608-001 from 20 A to 18 A.
2. Change the setting of SP2-630-003 from 47 to 11.
3. If the result of steps 1 and 2 are not satisfactory, decrease the setting of SP2-608-001 by 1 A until
a grainy image on OHP in the full color printing.
If the toner end message is displayed even though the toner bottle still has toner in itself, check the following
points.
1. Check if the setting of SP3044-001 to -004 is set to "4".
2. Check if the toner supply motor for each color works correctly with SP5804-071 to -074.
Replace the toner supply motor with a new motor if it is defective.
668
Troubleshooting Guide
3. Check if the red mark is painted besides the black cord of the toner supply motor. The left picture [A]
shows a correct motor and right picture [B] shows a malfunction motor.
Replace the toner supply motor with a new motor if the red mark is painted besides the red cord
of the toner supply motor.
4. Check if the gear [A] of the toner supply motor is attached to the motor shaft.
Replace the toner supply motor with a new motor if the gear of the toner supply motor is not
attached to the motor shaft.
5. Check if the toner supply drive shaft is correctly installed.
Install the tone supply drive shaft correctly if not.
This explains the troubleshooting for each paper jam code; Jam code 3, 4, 8, 11, 12, 17, 19, 51, 52
and 59. Refer to the following troubleshooting procedure corresponding to the paper jam code.
669
6. Troubleshooting
3. Check if the feed roller shaft [A] for the tray 1 rotates.
6
4. Replace the one-way clutch [A] with P/N D1051164 if the feed roller shaft does not rotate.
670
Troubleshooting Guide
5. Open the duplex unit with the paper feed motor rotating.
6. Press the surface of the vertical transport roller [A] for the tray 1 gently with a small piece of paper,
as shown above.
7. Replace the one-way clutch [A] with P/N D1051166 if the roller stops easily.
8. Ask a customer to fix the end fence and side fences in the tray 1 with the end fence stopper and screws
installed in the tray 1.
For details about fixing the end fence of the paper tray, see "Fixing the End Fence of the Paper
Tray" described below.
9. Instruct the customer to press down the paper stack until the bottom plate of the tray 1 is locked when
loading paper in the paper tray.
Fixing the End Fence of the Paper Tray
671
6. Troubleshooting
2. Hold the sides of the end fence [A], and then move it to the position as shown above.
672
Troubleshooting Guide
7. Pull the end fence stopper [A], and then tighten the screw.
8. Make sure that the end fence is firmly fixed.
6
Jam 4: Paper is not fed from Tray 2.
1. Pull out the tray 1 and tray 2 from the machine ( x 2 each).
2. Turn on the paper feed motor using SP5-804-013 (Output check: Paper Feed M2:CCW:190mm/
s).
3. Check if the feed roller shaft [A] for the tray 2 rotates.
673
6. Troubleshooting
6 4. Replace the one-way clutch [A] with P/N D1051164 if the feed roller shaft does not rotate.
5. Open the lower right door with the paper feed motor rotating.
6. Press the surface of the vertical transport roller [A] for the tray 2 gently with a small piece of paper,
as shown above.
674
Troubleshooting Guide
7. Replace the one-way clutch [A] with P/N D1051166 if the roller stops easily. 6
8. Ask a customer to fix the end fence and side fences in the tray 1 with the end fence stopper and screws
installed in the tray 1.
For details about fixing the end fence of the paper tray, see "Fixing the End Fence of the Paper
Tray" described below.
9. Instruct the customer to press down the paper stack until the bottom plate of the tray 1 is locked when
loading paper in the paper tray.
Fixing the End Fence of the Paper Tray
1. Pull out the paper tray from the machine.
2. Hold the sides of the end fence [A], and then move it to the position as shown above.
675
6. Troubleshooting
676
Troubleshooting Guide
7. Pull the end fence stopper [A], and then tighten the screw.
8. Make sure that the end fence is firmly fixed.
4. Press the surface of the vertical transport roller [A] for the tray 1 gently with a small piece of paper,
as shown above.
677
6. Troubleshooting
5. Replace the one-way clutch [A] with P/N D1051166 if the roller stops easily.
Jam 11: Vertical transport sensor 1 does not detect paper from the tray 1.
1. Remove the paper from the trays 1 and 2.
2. Open the lower right door.
3. Turn on the paper feed motor on using SP5-804-009 (Output check: Paper Feed M2:CW:190mm/
s).
4. Press the surface of the vertical transport roller [A] for the tray 2 gently with a small piece of paper,
as shown above.
5. Replace the one-way clutch with P/N D1051166 if the roller stops easily.
678
Troubleshooting Guide
6. If Jam 11 still occurs, replace the brackets [A] [B] for the vertical transport covers (Front: P/N
D0392943, Rear: P/N D0392944).
Jam 12: Vertical transport sensor 2 does not detect paper from Tray 2.
1. Remove the lower guide bracket ( p.268 "Vertical Transport Sensor ")
2. Press down on the vertical transport sensor bracket in the area around the emboss (bead) [A] as
shown above.
3. If there is a gap between this area of the bracket and the frame underneath it, replace the bracket
with P/N D0392929.
679
6. Troubleshooting
4. If Jam 11 still occurs, replace the brackets [A] [B] for the vertical transport covers (Front: P/N
D0392943, Rear: P/N D0392944).
4. Press the surface of the vertical transport roller [A] for the tray 1 gently with a small piece of paper,
as shown above.
5. Replace the one-way clutch [A] with P/N D1051166 if the roller stops easily.
680
Troubleshooting Guide
6. If Jam 17 still occurs, turn on the paper feed motor using SP5-804-009 (Output check: Paper Feed
M2:CW:190mm/s).
7. Press the surface of the vertical transport roller [A] for the tray 2 gently with a small piece of paper,
as shown above.
8. Replace the one-way clutch [A] with P/N D1051166 if the roller stops easily.
Jam 51/ Jam 52: Vertical transport sensor 1/2 does not turn off.
1. Open the lower right door.
681
6. Troubleshooting
2. Replace the brackets for the vertical transport covers (Front: P/N D0392943, Rear: P/N
D0392944).
Symptom:
A non-feed paper jam occurs when the machine tries to feed relatively heavy weight paper from the PFU.
Cause:
There is not enough pressure on the top sheet of paper stack to separate it from the other sheets.
Solution:
1. Instruct a customer to adjust the amount of paper stuck in the PFU when using heavy weight paper
types.
If the customer wants to use the heavy weight paper in the full load condition, try step 2.
682
Troubleshooting Guide
2. Replace the pressure tension springs (P/N D3312773) as shown above with special springs (P/N
D3312774) ( "Lift Motors" under the chapter Replacement and Adjustment" of the PFU service 6
manual).
Side Effect:
These "special springs" will increase the paper feed pressure. Therefore, if a customer uses thin paper types
after installing "special springs", multi-feeds may occur.
Fusing Temperature
Paper Transfer Current
600 dpi 1200 dpi
683
6. Troubleshooting
Special Paper 1-3 are designed for plain paper and Middle Thick paper types.
Special Paper 4-6 are designed for paper types equivalent to Thick paper 1 or thicker.
Special Paper 2-3 and 5-6 are intended to solve specific types of image problems, and Special Paper
1 and 4 are intended to be used as a customized mode if modes 2-6 are ineffective.
Special Paper 1:
Use this mode if the issue occurs only with a specific type of Plain Paper of Middle Thick Paper, and you
need to change (customize) the paper transfer current and/or fusing temperature settings. The default
settings for this mode are exactly the same as those for Middle Thick.
Special Paper 2:
Use this mode if poor fusing occurs only with a specific type of Plain Paper or Middle Thick Paper.
Special Paper 3:
6 Use this mode if blistered images occur only with a specific type of Plain Paper of Middle Thick Paper.
Special Paper 4:
Use this mode if the issue occurs only with a specific type of Thick Paper, and you need to change (customize)
the paper transfer current and/or fusing temperature settings. The default settings for this mode are exactly
the same as those for Thick Paper 1.
Special Paper 5:
Use this mode if poor fusing occurs only with a specific type of Thick Paper.
Special Paper 6:
Use this mode if blistered images occur only with a specific type of Thick Paper.
684
Troubleshooting Guide
Plain Paper or
Tray 1 to 4 Special Paper 1 to 3
Middle Thick
Tray 1 to 2
Bypass Tray
685
6. Troubleshooting
Special Paper 1 to 3
Paper Trays (Trays 1 4)
1. In User Tools, set the "Paper Type" and "Paper Thickness" for the target tray.
2. Inside the printer driver, set the "Paper Source Tray" and "Paper Type" to the same tray and paper
type that you selected in Step 1 above.
Bypass Tray
"Driver/Command" Priority (default)
Inside the printer driver, set the "Paper Source Tray" to the bypass tray, and the "Paper Type" to Special
Paper 1, 2, or 3.
The machine will ignore the "Paper Type" setting in User Tools.
"Machine Setting" Priority
1. In User Tools, set the "Paper Type" and "Paper Thickness" for the bypass tray.
2. Inside the printer driver, set the "Paper Source Tray" to the bypass tray, and the "Paper Type" to the
same paper type that you selected in Step 1 above.
686
Troubleshooting Guide
Special Paper 4 to 6
1. In User Tools, set the "Paper Type" and "Paper Thickness" for the target tray.
2. Inside the printer driver, set the "Paper Source Tray" to the target tray (from Step 1 above), and Paper
Type to "None".
Resolution
6
RTR standard Paper size correction co-efficient
Mode (Process Print side
current ( A) (%)
Speed)
2-411-005(S2),009(S3),013(S4),
Face side 2-403-001
600dpi 017(S5)
(120mm/s) 2-411-006(S2),010(S3),014(S4),
Back side 2-403-002
018(S5)
BW
2-411-007(S2),011(S3),015(S4),
Face side 2-403-003
1200dpi 019(S5)
(60mm/s) 2-411-008(S2),012(S3),016(S4),
Back side 2-403-004
020(S5)
2-412-005(S2),009(S3),013(S4),
Face side 2-407-001
600dpi 017(S5)
(120mm/s) 2-412-006(S2),010(S3),014(S4),
Back side 2-407-002
018(S5)
Color
2-412-007(S2),011(S3),015(S4),
Face side 2-407-003
1200dpi 019(S5)
(60mm/s) 2-412-008(S2),012(S3),016(S4),
Back side 2-407-004
020(S5)
687
6. Troubleshooting
Middle Thick
RTR standard
Resolution Paper size correction co-efficient
Mode Print side current
(Process Speed) (%)
( A)
RTR standard
Resolution Paper size correction co-efficient
Mode Print side current
(Process Speed) (%)
( A)
688
Troubleshooting Guide
Face side
BW 60mm/s Only 2-482-001
Only
Common with the Plain Paper 1
60mm/s Face side
Color 2-483-001
Only Only
Thick Paper 1
Thick Paper 2
Thick Paper 3
OHP
689
6. Troubleshooting
Special Paper 1
RTR standard
Resolution Paper size correction co-efficient
Mode Print side current
(Process Speed) (%)
( A)
Special Paper 2
RTR standard
Resolution Paper size correction co-efficient
Mode Print side current
(Process Speed) (%)
( A)
690
Troubleshooting Guide
Special Paper 3
RTR standard
Resolution Paper size correction co-efficient
Mode Print side current
(Process Speed)
( A)
(%)
6
600dpi
Face side 2-852-001
(120mm/s)
BW
1200dpi
Face side 2-852-003
(60mm/s)
Common with the Special Paper 1
600dpi
Face side 2-857-001
(120mm/s)
Color
1200dpi
Face side 2-857-003
(60mm/s)
Special Paper 4
RTR standard
Resolution Paper size correction co-efficient
Mode Print side current
(Process Speed) (%)
( A)
691
6. Troubleshooting
Special Paper 5
RTR standard
Resolution Paper size correction co-efficient
Mode Print side current
(Process Speed) (%)
( A)
Special Paper 6
RTR standard
Resolution Paper size correction co-efficient
Mode Print side current
(Process Speed) (%)
( A)
692
Jam Detection
Jam Detection
Paper Jam Display
134 A5 SEF - -
693
6. Troubleshooting
Mainframe
SP7-504 shows how many jams occurred at each location.
LCD
Jam Code SP Display Description
Display
7504 18 Fusing Entrance: ON Fusing entrance sensor does not detect paper. B
7504 19 Fusing Exit: ON Fusing exit sensor does not detect paper. C
7504 20 Paper Exit: ON Paper exit sensor does not detect paper. C
7504 25 Duplex Exit: ON Duplex exit sensor does not detect paper. Z
7504 27 Duplex Entrance: ON Duplex entrance sensor does not detect paper. Z
7504 28 1-Bin Exit Sensor 1-bin tray exit sensor does not detect paper. C
694
Jam Detection
LCD
Jam Code SP Display Description
Display
Vertical Transport
7504 51 Vertical transport sensor 1 does not turn off. A1, A2
Sensor1
Vertical Transport
7504 52 Vertical transport sensor 2 does not turn off. Y
Sensor2
Vertical Transport
7504 53 Vertical transport sensor 3 does not turn off. Y
Sensor3
7504 58 Fusing Entrance Sensor Fusing entrance sensor does not turn off. C
7504 59 Fusing Exit Sensor Fusing exit sensor does not turn off. C
7504 60 Exit Sensor Paper exit sensor does not turn off. C
6
7504 64 Inverter Sensor Inverter sensor does not turn off. C
7504 65 Duplex Exit Sensor Duplex exit sensor does not turn off. Z
7504 67 Duplex Entrance Sensor Duplex entrance sensor does not turn off. Z
7504 68 1-Bin Exit: ON 1-bin tray exit sensor does not turn off. R
695
6. Troubleshooting
LCD
Jam Code SP Display Description
Display
The jam location display depends on where a paper jam is detected at power-on.
696
Jam Detection
LCD
Jam Code SP Display Description
Display
7505 3 Skew Correction: ON Skew correction sensor does not detect paper. P
7505 53 Skew Correction: OFF Skew correction sensor does not turn off. P
7505 55 Paper Exit: OFF Exit Sensor does not turn off. P
697
6. Troubleshooting
Sensor Locations
698
Electrical Component Defects
The CN numbers in the following table are the connector numbers on the BCU.
Open/
ID Sensor: Front A CN214/8, 9 SC400
Shorted
6
Open/
S5 ID Sensor: Center A CN214/6, 7 SC400
Shorted
Open/
ID Sensor: Rear A CN214/2, 3 SC400
Shorted
Open/
S19 PTR Contact Sensor H CN232/4 SC452
Shorted
Open/
S35 Drum Phase Sensor: K H CN220/2 SC380/SC396
Shorted
699
6. Troubleshooting
Open/
S12 ITB Rotation Sensor H/L CN219/20 SC443
Shorted
Open/
Paper size error
CN211/11, Shorted
SW6 Tray 1 Paper Size Switch L
12, 13, 15
Tray 1 is detected when tray
Shorted
1 is not set.
Open/
S16 By-pass HP Sensor H CN221/21 SC508
Shorted
700
Electrical Component Defects
CN212/B9, Open/
S34 TD Sensor - K A SC372
B11 Shorted
CN212/A9, Open/
S32 TD Sensor - M A SC373
A11 Shorted
6
CN212/B3, Open/
S33 TD Sensor - C A SC374
B5 Shorted
CN212/A3, Open/
S31 TD Sensor - Y A SC375
A5 Shorted
701
6. Troubleshooting
Open/
Paper size error
CN211/16, Shorted
SW7 Tray 2 Paper Size Switch L
17, 18, 20
Tray 2 is detected when the
Shorted
tray 2 is not set.
Open/
S28 Thermopile A CN237/14 SC541
Shorted
Open/
TH1 Heating Roller Thermistor A CN233/4 SC551
Shorted
702
Electrical Component Defects
Open SC120
S3 Scanner HP Sensor H CN205/2
Shorted SC121
Open/
S20 ITB Contact Sensor L CN234/5 SC442
Shorted
Rating
Fuse Symptom when turning on the main switch
120V 220V - 240V
FU102 10A/125V 5A/250V No response. (5V power to the PSU is not supplied.)
703
6. Troubleshooting
Rating
Fuse Symptom when turning on the main switch
120V 220V - 240V
FU9 10A/125V 10A/250V 24V power to the DRB and controller is not supplied.
For continued protection against risk of fire, replace only with same type and rating of fuse.
704
Scanner Test Mode
Output the SBU test pattern with SP4-807-001 to make sure the scanner SBU control operates correctly.
The SBU test pattern prints out after you have set the SP mode settings and pressed the start key.
The CCD on the SBU board may be defective if the copy is abnormal and the SBU test pattern is
normal.
The followings can be the cause if the copy is normal and the SBU test pattern is abnormal:
The harness may not be correctly connected between the SBU and the IPU.
The IPU or SBU board may be defective.
You can check the IPU board with the SP mode menu, SP4-904-1.
6
If no error is detected, the test ends. Then the completion code shows in the operation panel display. If an
error is detected, the test is interrupted. Then an error code shows. The table below lists the completion and
error codes.
705
6. Troubleshooting
706
7. Energy Saving
Energy Save
Energy Saver Modes
Customers should use energy saver modes properly, to save energy and protect the environment.
The area shaded grey in this diagram represents the amount of energy that is saved when the timers are
at the default settings. If the timers are changed, then the energy saved will be different. For example, if
the timers are all set to 240 min., the grey area will disappear, and no energy is saved before 240 min.
expires.
Timer Settings
The user can set these timers with User Tools (System settings > Timer setting)
Auto off timer (1 240 min): Off/Sleep Mode
Default settings: 1 min.
707
7. Energy Saving
Recommendation
We recommend that the default settings should be kept.
If the customer requests that these settings should be changed, please explain that their energy costs
could increase, and that they should consider the effects on the environment of extra energy use.
If it is necessary to change the settings, please try to make sure that the Auto Off timer is not too long.
Try with a shorter setting first, such as 30 min., then go to a longer one (such as 60 min.) if the customer
is not satisfied.
If the timers are all set to the maximum value, the machine will not begin saving energy until 240
minutes has expired after the last job. This means that after the customer has finished using the machine
for the day, energy will be consumed that could otherwise be saved.
If you change the settings, the energy consumed can be measured using SP8941, as explained below.
SP 8941 (Machine Status) keeps a record of the amount of time that the machine spends in each mode.
8941-001: Operating mode
8941-002: Standby mode
8941-003: Panel off mode (Not used in this model)
8941-004: Low power mode (Not used in this model)
8941-005: Off/sleep mode
With this data, and the power consumption values from the specifications, we can estimate the amount of
energy that is used by the machine.
This should only be used as a reference value, because the power consumption specifications are measured
in a controlled environment with a constant power supply.
To get an exact measurement at the customers site, a watt meter must be used to measure the actual energy
consumed.
To use SP8941 to calculate the energy consumed:
At the start of the measurement period, read the values of SP8941 001 to 005.
At the end of the measurement period, read the values of SP8941 001 to 005 again.
708
Energy Save
Find the amount of time spent in each mode (subtract the earlier measurement from the later
measurement).
Multiply this by the power consumption spec for each mode.
Convert the result to kWh (kilowatt hours)
Here is an example calculation.
Power
Time Consumptio
Machine Power SP8941: Start Time: End Time: Differences n (Data:a x
Consumption Machine (min.) Data: (min.) Data: (Data:b - Data:d)
Date (W): Data: a Status b c Data: c) (Wmin.)
(min.) Data: d
Data: e
001:
Operatin
1081.8 Operatin 21089.0 21386.0 297.0 321294.6
g mode
g Time
Ready 002:
mode 214.0 Standby 306163.0 308046.0 1883.0 402962.0
(stand by) Time
Energy 003: 7
mode 214.0 Energy 71386.0 75111.0 3725.0 797150.0
(Panel off) Save Time
1947781.6
Total Power Consumption of Data: e (Wmin.)
0
709
7. Energy Saving
Paper Save
Effectiveness of Duplex/Combine Function
Duplexing and the combine functions reduce the amount of paper used. This means that less energy overall
is used for paper production, which improves the environment.
1. Duplex:
2. Combine mode:
710
Paper Save
3. Duplex + Combine:
Using both features together can further reduce paper volume by 3/4!
To check the paper consumption, look at the total counter and the duplex counter.
The total counter counts all pages printed.
For one duplex page, the total counter goes up by 2.
For a duplex job of a three-page original, the total counter goes up by 3.
The duplex counter counts pages that have images on both sides.
For one duplex page, the duplex counter goes up by 1.
For a duplex job of a three-page original, the duplex counter will only increase by 1, even though 7
two sheets are used.
Recommendation
Please explain the above features to the customers, so that they can reduce their paper usage.
Model DI-C1.5
Total counter: SP 8581-001
Duplex counter: SP 8411-001
Single-sided with combine mode: SP 8421-004
Duplex with combine mode: SP 8421-005
The following table shows paper savings and how the counters increase for some simple examples of
single-sided and duplex jobs
Duplex mode:
1 1 1 0 1 0
711
7. Energy Saving
2 2 1 1 2 1
3 3 2 1 3 1
4 4 2 2 4 2
5 5 3 2 5 2
10 10 5 5 10 5
20 20 10 10 20 10
If combine mode is used, the total and duplex counters work in the same way as explained previously. The
following table shows paper savings and how the counters increase for some simple examples of duplex/
combine jobs.
2 in 1 mode:
1 1 1 0 1 1
2 2 1 1 1 1
3 3 2 1 2 2
4 4 2 2 2 2
5 5 3 2 3 2
10 10 5 5 5 5
20 20 10 10 10 10
Duplex + 2 in 1 mode:
1 1 1 0 1 1
2 2 1 1 1 1
712
Paper Save
3 3 1 2 2 2
4 4 1 3 2 2
5 5 2 3 3 3
6 6 2 4 3 3
7 7 2 5 4 4
8 8 2 6 4 4
9 9 3 6 5 5
10 10 3 7 5 5
11 11 3 8 6 6
12 12 3 9 6 6
713
7. Energy Saving
714
Model DI-C1.5
Machine Code: D104/D106
Appendices
17 December, 2010
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. Appendix: Specifications
General Specifications.......................................................................................................................................3
Copier.............................................................................................................................................................3
Printer...............................................................................................................................................................7
Scanner...........................................................................................................................................................8
Supported Paper Sizes.......................................................................................................................................9
Paper Feed......................................................................................................................................................9
Paper Exit......................................................................................................................................................12
Platen/ARDF Original Size Detection........................................................................................................16
Software Accessories.......................................................................................................................................18
Printer and LAN Fax Drivers........................................................................................................................18
Scanner Driver.............................................................................................................................................18
Utility Software.............................................................................................................................................19
Optional Equipment.........................................................................................................................................20
ARDF (D541)...............................................................................................................................................20
Paper Feed Unit (D425)..............................................................................................................................20
Paper Feed Unit (D331)..............................................................................................................................21
Internal Finisher (D429) and Punch Unit (D390)......................................................................................22
Shift Tray (D428).........................................................................................................................................23
1-bin Tray Unit (D426)...............................................................................................................................23
Side Tray (D427).........................................................................................................................................24
Envelope Feeder EF3010 (D559).............................................................................................................24
2. Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables
Maintenance Tables........................................................................................................................................25
Preventive Maintenance Items....................................................................................................................25
Others Yield Parts.........................................................................................................................................27
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
System SP1-xxx................................................................................................................................................31
SP1-XXX (Feed)............................................................................................................................................31
System SP2xxx.................................................................................................................................................71
SP2-XXX (Drum)...........................................................................................................................................71
System SP3xxx...............................................................................................................................................157
SP3-XXX (Process).....................................................................................................................................157
1
System SP4xxx...............................................................................................................................................207
SP4-XXX (Scanner)....................................................................................................................................207
System SP5xxx...............................................................................................................................................230
SP5-XXX (Mode).......................................................................................................................................230
System SP6xxx...............................................................................................................................................295
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)...............................................................................................................................295
System SP7-xxx..............................................................................................................................................298
SP7-XXX (Data Log)..................................................................................................................................298
System SP8-xxx..............................................................................................................................................333
SP8-xxx: Data Log2..................................................................................................................................333
Input and Output Check Tables....................................................................................................................377
Input Check Table.....................................................................................................................................377
Output Check Table..................................................................................................................................386
Test Pattern Printing........................................................................................................................................393
Printer Service Mode.....................................................................................................................................395
SP1-XXX (Service Mode)..........................................................................................................................395
Scanner SP Mode..........................................................................................................................................404
SP1-xxx (System and Others)...................................................................................................................404
SP2-XXX (Scanning-image quality)..........................................................................................................405
INDEX...........................................................................................................................................................407
2
1. Appendix: Specifications
General Specifications 1
Copier
Configuration: Desktop
3
1. Appendix: Specifications
Color:
9.2 seconds or less (A4/LT LEF)
First copy (normal mode): Black & white:
6.4 seconds or less (A4/LT LEF) for NA model
6.3 seconds or less (A4/LT LEF) for EU/AA model
4
General Specifications
- Minimum Maximum
Tray 1/ Tray 2
A5 (LEF)/
A3/11" x 17"
1
Print Paper Size: 8.5" x 11"
A5 (LEF)/
Optional Tray A3/11" x 17"
8.5" x 11"
5
1. Appendix: Specifications
NA Europe
1 25% 25%
50% 50%
65% 65%
73% 71%
78% 75%
93% 93%
100% 100%
121% 115%
129% 122%
155% 141%
200% 200%
400% 400%
(*1) The complete system consists of mainframe, ARDF, finisher, and LCT.
The above measurements were made in accordance with Ricoh standard methodology.
Dimensions (W x D x H):
Copier: 587 x 676 x 725 mm (23.1" x 26.7" x 28.5")
Copier + PFU + Right tray + Internal finisher: 1009 x 676 x 1117 mm (39.7" x 26.7" x 44.0")
6
General Specifications
1
Printer
PCL 5c/6:
300 x 300 dpi : Available only in B/W mode
Resolution and 600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits), Fine (4 bit)
Gradation: PS3:
600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits), Fine (4 bit)
1200 dpi x 1200 dpi
C1.5a:
20 ppm in Plain/Middle Thick mode
12.5 ppm in Thick/OHP mode (depending on paper type)
Printing speed:
C1.5c:
25 ppm in Plain/Middle Thick mode
12.5 ppm in Thick/OHP mode (depending on paper type)
USB2.0: Standard
Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T): Standard
Host Interfaces: Gigabit Ethernet (1000 Base-T): Optional
IEEE1284 parallel x 1: Optional
IEEE802.11a/g, g (Wireless LAN): Optional
7
1. Appendix: Specifications
1
Scanner
Twain Mode:
Available scanning 100 to1200 dpi
Resolution Range: Delivery Mode:
100/200/300/400/600 dpi
8
Supported Paper Sizes
Size
Paper BT T1/2 T3/4 DU
(W x L)
A3 W 12" x 18" M - - -
Government Legal
8.25" x 14" M M M M
SEF
9
1. Appendix: Specifications
Size
Paper BT T1/2 T3/4 DU
(W x L)
8.25" x 13" M M M M
11" x 15" M M M M
Folio SEF
10" x 14" M M M M
8" x 10" M M M M
8K 267 x 390mm M M M M
Custom M M M -
Remarks:
- Not supported
10
Supported Paper Sizes
Europe/ Asia
BT: By-pass Tray, T1/2: Tray 1/2 (standard), T3/4: Tray 3/4 (option), DU: Duplex Unit
Paper
Size
BT T1/2 T3/4 DU
1
(W x L)
A3 W 12" x 18" M - - -
Government Legal
8.25" x 14" M M M M
SEF
11
1. Appendix: Specifications
Size
Paper BT T1/2 T3/4 DU
(W x L)
1 8.25" x 13" M M M M
11" x 15" M M M M
Folio SEF
10" x 14" M M M M
8" x 10" M M M M
8K 267 x 390mm M M M M
Custom M M M -
Remarks:
- Not supported
Paper Exit
12
Supported Paper Sizes
A3 W 12" x 18" Y - - -
Government
8.25" x 14" Y Y Y Y
Legal SEF
13
1. Appendix: Specifications
8.25" x 13" Y Y Y Y
1 Folio SEF
11" x 15" Y Y Y Y
10" x 14" Y Y Y Y
8" x 10" Y Y Y Y
8K 267 x 390 mm Y Y Y Y
Custom Y - Y -
Remarks:
Y Supported
- Not supported
Internal Finisher
Str: Straight Feed Out/ Inv: Inverter Path/ Srt; Sort/ Stp: Staple/ 2/3P: 2/3 Holes Punch/ 4P: 4 Holes
Punch/ S4P: Scandinavia 4 Holes Punch/ RT: Right Tray
Internal finisher
Paper Size (W x L)
Str Inv Srt Stp 2/3P 4P S4P
A3 W 12" x 18" - - - - - - -
14
Supported Paper Sizes
Internal finisher
Paper Size (W x L)
Str Inv Srt Stp 2/3P 4P S4P
Government
8.25" x 14" Y Y 10 30 - - -
Legal SEF
8.25" x 13" Y Y 10 30 - - -
11" x 15" Y Y 10 30 - - -
Folio SEF
10" x 14" Y Y - - - - -
8" x 10" Y Y - - - - -
8K 267 x 390 mm Y Y 10 30 - - -
15
1. Appendix: Specifications
Internal finisher
Paper Size (W x L)
Str Inv Srt Stp 2/3P 4P S4P
Custom - - - - - - -
Remarks:
30 Output up to 30 sheets
50 Output up to 50 sheets
- Not supported
16
Supported Paper Sizes
A5 (210 x 148) S - - Y Y
B6 (128 x 182) L - - - - 1
B6 (182 x 128) S - - - -
10" x 14" - Y - -
*1: Use SP4-303 to detect original sizes as A5 lengthwise/HLT when the message Can-t detect original
size shows.
*2: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP6-016-1.
*3: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP4-305-1.
*4: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP5-126-1.
17
1. Appendix: Specifications
Software Accessories
The printer drivers and utility software are provided as following two CD-ROMs
1 1: Printer Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM
2: Scanner Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM.
An auto-run installer lets you to select the components you want to install.
MacOS8.6 to 9.x,
Windows 2000, XP, Server 2003, Vista, MacOSX10.1
Printer Language
Server 2008, 7
or later
PCL5c
Yes No
/ PCL6
RPCS No No
The PCL5c/6 and PS3 drivers are provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM
The PS3 drivers are all genuine Adobe PS drivers, except for Windows 2000/XP/2003/Vista/7.
Windows 2000 uses Microsoft PS. A PPD file for each operating system is provided with the driver.
The PPD installer for Macintosh supports Mac OS X 10.1 or later versions.
The LAN Fax driver lets you fax documents directly form your PC. Address Book Editor and Cover
Sheet Editor are to be installed as well. (These require the optional fax unit.)
Scanner Driver
18
Software Accessories
Utility Software
Software Description
Font Manager A font management utility with screen fonts for the printer
1
(2000/XP/Server 2003/7) This is provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM
19
1. Appendix: Specifications
Optional Equipment
1 ARDF (D541)
Copy - 32 to 200 %
20
Optional Equipment
Power Consumption: 15 W 1
Dimensions (W x D x H): 550 mm x 520 mm x 137 mm (22" x 20.8" x 5.48")
21
1. Appendix: Specifications
No punch mode:
1 A3/11" x 17" to B6/5.5" x 8.5" (SEF)
Punch mode:
2 holes:
A3, A4 or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 14" (SEF), 8.5" x 13" (SEF), 8.5" x 11"
3 holes:
A3, A4 (LEF) or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 11" (LEF)
Print Paper Size:
4 holes (Europe):
A3, A4 (LEF) or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 11" (LEF)
4 holes (Scandinavia):
A3, A4 or 11" x 17", 8.5" x 14" (SEF), 8.5" x 13" (SEF), 8.5" x 11",
7.25" x 10.5"
Staple mode:
A3/11" x 17" to B5/8.5" x 11"
No punch mode:
52 to 256 g/m2 (14 to 68 lb.)
Punch mode:
Paper Weight: 52 to 105 g/m2 (14 to 28 lb.)
Staple mode:
52 to 128 g/m2 (14 to 34 lb.)
Label/Thick paper/OHP cannot be stapled
3 positions
Staple position: 1-staple: 2 positions (Top/ Bottom)
2-staples: 1 position
22
Optional Equipment
Finisher:
Dimensions (W x D x H):
535 x 525 x 205 mm (21.1" x 20.7" x 8.1")
Punch Unit:
1
98 x 500 x 165 mm (3.9" x 19.7" x 6.5")
Paper Capacity: 250 sheet (A4/ 81/2" x 111/2" or smaller: 80g/m2/ 20 lbs)
Standard sizes
A6 SEF to A3, HLT to DLT
Paper Size: Non-standard sizes
Width: 90 to 305 mm
Length: 148 to 600 mm
Standard Size:
Paper Size:
A3 /DLT to A5/ HLT SEF
23
1. Appendix: Specifications
1
Side Tray (D427)
Standard Size:
Paper Size:
A3 /DLT to A5/ HLT SEF
Weight: 1.5 kg
250 sheets
Tray Capacity:
150 sheets (A5SEF/ A6SEF/ B6SEF/ Half Letter SEF)
Power Source: -
Power Consumption: -
24
2. Appendix: Preventive Maintenance
Tables
Maintenance Tables
2
Preventive Maintenance Items
Mainframe
Scanner
PCDU
Drum Unit-K, C, M, Y R
25
2. Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables
ID Sensors C Alcohol
2 Fusing
Alcohol
Pressure Roller C* C
*: Clean it if dirty.
Others
Dust Filter R
The cleaning unit prevents the pressure roller from getting dirty due to paper dust.
Paper Feed
Damp cloth
Registration Roller C*1 C
Never use alcohol.
26
Maintenance Tables
Duplex
Paper Exit
*1: The registration roller requires a cleaning maintenance every 60 K (total count).
The parts mentioned in these tables have a target yield. However, the total copy/print volume made by
the machine will not reach the target yield within the machines targeted lifetime if the machine is used
under the target usage conditions (ACV, color ratio, P/J, and C/O). So, these parts are categorized not
as PM parts but as yield parts (EM parts).
Mainframe
PCDU
27
2. Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables
Development Unit-K, C, M, Y R
PTR unit R
2 Fusing
Fusing Unit R
ARDF (D366)
28
Maintenance Tables
Bearing C S552R
Items EM Remarks
29
2. Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables
30
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
System SP1-xxx
SP1-XXX (Feed)
31
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Side-to-Side Registration]
Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the laser main scan start position for each
1002 mode and tray.
Increasing a value: an image is moved to the rear edge of paper.
Decreasing a value: an image is moved to the front edge of paper.
32
System SP1-xxx
33
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Enables or disables the automatic paper size detection function of the by-pass tray.
001
This SP determines what paper size the machine detects if the detected size is less than 8.5".
0: LT SEF (default), 1: LG
34
System SP1-xxx
35
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3 Temp.:Delta:Warm:BW:Cent
er
*ENG [0 to 100 / 10 / 1 deg/step]
020
Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) in the black and white mode
when the fusing unit is determined as warm state.
36
System SP1-xxx
Temp.:Delta:Cold:
101 *ENG [0 to 100 / NA: 20, EU/AA: 15 / 1 deg/step]
BW2:Center
Temp.:Delta:Warm:
105 *ENG [0 to 100 / 10 / 1 deg/step]
BW2:Center
Temp.:Delta:Warm:
106 *ENG [0 to 100 / 45 / 1 deg/step]
BW2:End
Temp.:Delta:Warm:
107 *ENG [0 to 200 / 55 / 1 deg/step]
BW2:Press
Temp.:Delta:Hot:
109 *ENG [0 to 100 / 10 / 1 deg/step]
BW2:Center
-001 DFU
to -005 These SPs are desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
37
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
-007 DFU
to -011 These SPs are desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
3 Temp.:Lower
007 *ENG [0 to 100 / NA: 20, EU/AA: 11 / 1 deg/step]
Delta:Center:Sp.1
Temp.:Upper
009 *ENG [0 to 50 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
Delta:Center:Sp.1
-013 DFU
to -017 These SPs are desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
Temp.:Lower
013 *ENG [0 to 100 / 30 / 1 deg/step]
Delta:Center:Sp.2
Temp.:Upper
015 *ENG [0 to 50 / 20 / 1 deg/step]
Delta:Center:Sp.2
-019 DFU
to -024 These SPs are desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
38
System SP1-xxx
Temp.:Lower
020 *ENG [0 to 100 / 25 / 1 deg/step]
Delta:Center:Sp.3
Temp.:Upper
022 *ENG [0 to 50 / 10 / 1 deg/step]
Delta:Center:Sp.3
001 Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value for each destination is the upper limit for this setting.
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.
002
DFU:
This SP is desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
39
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
003 Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value for each destination is the upper limit for this setting.
3 004
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
DFU:
This SP is desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
005 Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value for each destination is the upper limit for this setting.
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in full coloe printing.
006
DFU:
This SP is desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
007 Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value for each destination is the upper limit for this setting.
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
008
DFU:
This SP is desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
40
System SP1-xxx
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+10C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
41
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
42
System SP1-xxx
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Plain1:FC:Press:Low Speed
102 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
(DFU)
Plain1:BW:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
103
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Plain1:BW:Press:Low Speed
104 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
(DFU)
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Plain2:FC:Press:Low Speed
106 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
(DFU)
43
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Plain2:BW:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 200 / 105 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
107
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Plain2:BW:Press:Low Speed
108 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
(DFU)
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Thin:FC:Press:Low Speed
110 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
(DFU)
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Thin:BW:Press:Low Speed
112 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
(DFU)
M-Thick:FC:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 200 / 115 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
113
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
M-Thick:FC:Press:Low Speed
114 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
(DFU)
M-Thick:BW:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 200 / 110 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
115
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
M-Thick:BW:Press:Low
116 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed (DFU)
44
System SP1-xxx
Special1:FC:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 200 / 115 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
117
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Special1:FC:Press:Low
118 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed (DFU)
Special1:BW:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG [100 to 200 / 110 / 1 deg/step]
3
119
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Special1:BW:Press:Low
120 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed (DFU)
Special2:FC:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
121
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Special2:FC:Press:Low
122 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed (DFU)
Special2:BW:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 200 / 115 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
123
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Special2:BW:Press:Low
124 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed (DFU)
Special3:FC:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 200 / 110 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
125
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Special3:FC:Press:Low
126 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed (DFU)
45
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Special3:BW:Center:Low
*ENG [100 to 200 / 105 / 1 deg/step]
Speed
127
Usage Limitation:
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Special3:BW:Press:Low
128 *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
Speed (DFU)
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
Envelop:Press:Low Speed
134 *ENG [0 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]
(DFU)
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
46
System SP1-xxx
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting. 3
144 Special4:BW:Press (DFU) *ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
47
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
+5C against the default value is the upper limit for this setting.
The heating roller has two lamps. One heats the center of the heating roller and the other
heats both ends of the heating roller.
48
System SP1-xxx
-002 DFU
to -006 These SPs are desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the print ready condition.
008
DFU
This SP is desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
49
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Specifies the additional temperature for the target temperature when the environmental
condition is determined as high temperature.
50
System SP1-xxx
These SPs are used for the fusing temperature control for variable job images. This control
saves the power comsumption when the machine copies or prints a job text image in black
and white mode.
Temp.:Normal:Center:Level1
(DFU)
*ENG [-10 to 10 / 0 / 1 /step] 3
Specifies the subtractive temperature level 1 of the fusing temperature control for variable
001
job images.
DFU
This SP is desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
Specifies the subtractive temperature level 2 of the fusing temperature control for variable
002
job images.
Usage Limitation:
Use 0C or less for this setting.
51
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
Execute Pattern *ENG
001 0: OFF, 1: ON
-002 to
-006, DFU
-008, These SPs are desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
3 -009
Humidity:Threshold:M-
*ENG [0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]
002 humid
Specifies the threshold between low and middle humidity.
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:M-
*ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
004 humid
Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in middle humidity.
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press: H-
*ENG [0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]
005 humid
Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in high humidity.
Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the stand-by mode.
52
System SP1-xxx
Temp.:Threshold:
*ENG [0 to 200 / 80 / 1 deg/step]
002 Atmosphere
Specifies the threshold temperature inside the machine for the heat storage feedback control. 3
[Target Temp. Correction] DFU
1115
This SP is desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted setting.
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1 /step]
Execution mode *ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON: BW, 2: ON: BW/FC
Usage Limitation:
Use "0: OFF" or "1: ON: BW" only.
DFU
-011
The following SPs below are desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted
to -106
setting.
Delay:Standard Speed:BW:
022 *ENG [0 to 20,000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]
1
53
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Delay:Standard Speed:BW:
032 *ENG [0 to 20,000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]
2
Paper Thickness
051 *ENG [0 to 100 / 20 / 1 /step]
Coefficient:Plain1
Paper Thickness
052 *ENG [0 to 100 / 20 / 1 /step]
Coefficient:Plain2
Paper Thickness
055 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Thick1
Paper Thickness
056 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Thick2
Paper Thickness
057 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Thick3
Paper Thickness
058 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Special1
Paper Thickness
059 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Special2
Paper Thicknes
060 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Special3
Paper Thickness
061 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Envelop
Paper Thickness
071 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Plain1:Low Speed
54
System SP1-xxx
Paper Thickness
072 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Plain2:Low Speed
Paper Thickness
073 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Thin:Low Speed
Paper Thickness
075
Coeff.:Special1:Low Speed
*ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
3
Paper Thickness
076 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Special2:Low Speed
Paper Thickness
077 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Special3:Low Speed
Paper Thickness
078 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Plain1:Glossy
Paper Thickness
079 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Plain2:Glossy
Paper Thickness
082 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Envelop:Low Speed
Paper Thickness
101 *ENG [0 to 100 / 200 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Special4
Paper Thickness
102 *ENG [0 to 100 / 200 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Special5
Paper Thicknes
103 *ENG [0 to 100 / NA: 75, EU/AA: 70 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Special6
Paper Thickness
104 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Envelop:Thick1
Paper Thickness
105 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Envelop:Thick2
55
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Paper Thickness
106 *ENG [0 to 100 / 0 / 1 /step]
Coeff.:Envelop:Thick3
Temp:Other:Center1:LowSpee
019 *ENG [-35 to 35 / 20 / 1C/step]
d
56
System SP1-xxx
Temp:Other.Center2:LowSpee
021 *ENG [-35 to 35 / 20 / 1C/step]
d
DFU
-002
The following SPs below are desgined for the factory use only. Do not change the adjusted
to -010
setting.
57
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Specifies the CPM down threshold temperature for the low temperature condition. If the fusing
temperature decreases -20C (adjustable) below the target temperature, the machine enters
the CPM down mode.
Specifies the CPM up threshold temperature for the low temperature condition. If the fusing
temperature increases -15C (adjustable) below the target temperature, the machine enters
the CPM up mode.
Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
Specifies the 2nd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
Specifies the 3rd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
Specifies the 3rd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
58
System SP1-xxx
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A3 paper size.
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A3 paper size.
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A3 paper size.
3
High:1st CPM Down
012 *ENG [100 to 225 / 175 / 1 deg/step]
Temp.:A4
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A4 paper size.
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A4 paper size.
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A4 paper size.
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of B5 paper size.
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of B5 paper size.
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of B5 paper size.
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A5 paper size.
59
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A5 paper size.
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A5 paper size.
3 Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A6 paper size.
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A6 paper size.
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A6 paper size.
60
System SP1-xxx
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Productivity Priority mode
001 Feed Permit Condition *ENG
1: Quality Priority mode 1
2: Quality Priority mode 1
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
001 Control Method Switch *ENG
0: FIXED, 1: CONTROL
[PowerControl]
003 *ENG [-4 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]
Power Offset
[Voltage Detection]
013 *ENG [0 to 200 / 80 / 1C/step]
Temp.:Threshold Value
61
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
62
System SP1-xxx
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
SC Display *ENG
001 0: ON, 1: OFF
63
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Execute - -
001 Executes the nip band measurement between heating roller and pressure roller.
If the nip band width is not 8 mm, and fusing is not good, replace the pressure roller or install
a new fusing unit.
3 003
Stop Time * ENG [0 to 100 / 20 / 1 sec/step]
64
System SP1-xxx
65
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
66
System SP1-xxx
These SPs can adjust the sub-scan magnification error. However, first read the "Sub-scan
1803 Magnification Error" in the "Troubleshooting Guide" (Main Chapters) to execute these SPs.
NEVER EXECUTE these SPs before reading the "Sub-scan Magnification Error". Otherwise,
color registration errors occur on outputs and this cannot be recovered by the line position
adjustment.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
001 Execute -
Execute drum phase adjustment.
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1]
Displays the result of drum phase adjustment.
002 Result *ENG 0: Successfully done
2: Sampling failure
3: Insufficient detection number
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1]
Turns the automatic drum phase adjustment on or
003 Auto Execution *ENG
off.
0: Off, 1: On
67
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
68
System SP1-xxx
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
State *ENG
001 0: Off, 1: On
69
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
70
System SP2xxx
System SP2xxx
SP2-XXX (Drum)
Adjusts the DC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes.
3
Charge bias (DC component) is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore,
adjusting these settings does not effect while process control mode (SP3-041-1 Default: ON)
is activated. When deactivating process control mode with SP3-041-1, the values in these
SP modes are used for printing.
71
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for LL environment (Low temperature
and Low humidity).
72
System SP2xxx
73
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
74
System SP2xxx
75
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3 001 Bk *ENG
002 C *ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]
003 M *ENG
004 Y *ENG
The drum lubrication mode interrupts the copy/print job to prevent the drum filming or
cleaning problem after the high coverage image printing if some conditions are met. The
following SPs can be adjusted for the drum lubrication mode.
76
System SP2xxx
008
Application Time:1 *ENG [0 to 99 / 0 / 1 sec./step]
3
Specifies the execution time for the drum lubrication mode of the setting 1 (SP2-016-002).
77
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
These values are the parameters for the automatic line position adjustment and are adjusted
2101 at the factory. However, you must input a value for SP2101-001 after replacing the laser
optics housing unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and
Adjustment" section. The value should be provided with the new laser optics housing unit.
[Magnification Adjust]
2102 These values are the parameters for the automatic line position adjustment and are adjusted
at the factory. These SPs must be input only when a new laser unit is installed.
78
System SP2xxx
79
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Bk *ENG
002 C *ENG
[80 to 120 / 100 / 1 %/step]
003 M *ENG
004 Y *ENG
3
[LD Power Adjust] DFU
(Process Speed, Color)
2105 Adjusts the LD power of each color for each process speed.
Each LD power setting is decided by process control.
High Speed: 120 mm/sec, Low Speed: 60 mm/sec
[Image Parameter]
2107
DFU
80
System SP2xxx
[Test Pattern]
2109
Generates the test pattern using "COPY Window" tab in the LCD.
0 None 3
1: Vertical Line (1dot) 12. Independent Pattern (2dot)
2: Vertical Line (2dot) 13. Independent Pattern (4dot)
3: Horizontal (1dot) 14. Trimming Area
4: Horizontal (2dot) 16: Hounds Tooth Check (Horizontal)
003 5: Grid Vertical Line 17: Band (Horizontal)
6: Grid Horizontal Line 18: Band (Vertical)
7: Grid pattern Small 19: Checker Flag Pattern
8: Grid pattern Large 20: Grayscale Vertical Margin
9: Argyle Pattern Small 21: Grayscale Horizontal Margin
10: Argyle Pattern Large 23: Full Dot Pattern
11. Independent Pattern (1dot)
006 Density: Bk -
Specifies the color density for the test pattern.
007 Density: C - [0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
81
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Skew Adjustment]
001 Execute: C *ENG Changes the current skew adjustment values to the
values specified with SP2117.
002 Execute: M *ENG
These SPs must be used when a new laser optics
housing unit is installed. For details, see "Laser
003 Execute: Y *ENG Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and
Adjustment" section.
82
System SP2xxx
001 C *ENG
003 Y *ENG
[P-Sensor Test]
[TM-Sensor Test]
[P-Sensor Test]
[TM-Sensor Test]
[P-Sensor Test]
83
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[TM-Sensor Test]
3 [P-Sensor Test]
[TM-Sensor Test]
[P-Sensor Test]
[TM-Sensor Test]
84
System SP2xxx
[P-Sensor Test]
[TM-Sensor Test]
Adjusts the magnification for each area. The main scan (297 mm) is divided into 8 areas.
Area 1 is at the front side of the machine (left side of the image) and area 8 is at the rear
2150 side of the machine (right side of the image).
Decreasing a value makes the image shift to the left side on the print.
Increasing a value makes the image shift to the right side on the print.
1 pulse = 1/16 dot
85
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
86
System SP2xxx
87
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
88
System SP2xxx
89
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
90
System SP2xxx
91
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
92
System SP2xxx
93
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
94
System SP2xxx
95
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 boolean /step]
0: Adjusted with Bk
011 S. Scan Cor. Setting *ENG
1: Adjusted in minimum shift among four
3 colors
96
System SP2xxx
97
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
98
System SP2xxx
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode.
006 The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in BW printing mode reaches
the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009 is
satisfied.
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode.
007 The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in color printing mode
3
reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009
is satisfied.
008 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment
once). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several
conditions. Section Descriptions" section.
011 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment
twice). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several
conditions.
99
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
007 Execution Result *ENG
0: Completed successfully, 1: Failed
001 Error Time Set *ENG [0.1 to 9.9 / 4 / 0.1 sec /step]
2220 Resets the value of the skew adjustment motor for each color.
These SPs must be executed when a new laser optics housing unit is installed. For details,
see "Laser Unit" in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section.
100
System SP2xxx
Adjusts the fixed LD power for each line speed and color.
2221
These SPs are activated only when SP3-041-002 is set to "0".
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
101
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Ambient Temp/Hum:Display]
2241
Displays the environment temperature and humidity.
102
System SP2xxx
103
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
104
System SP2xxx
105
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2403 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
2407 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in full color mode.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
106
System SP2xxx
[Plain-T:SizeCorrect:BW]
2411 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
002 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S1 *ENG [100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1 *ENG S1 size > 290 mm (Paper width)
3
004 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd: S1 *ENG
107
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Plain-T:SizeCorrect:FC]
2412 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
108
System SP2xxx
002 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S1 *ENG [100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step]
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1 *ENG S1 size > 290 mm (Paper width)
109
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Pain-T:Size-Env.Correct:BW] DFU
2413 Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1 *ENG S1 size > 290 mm (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 23 / 1/step]
005 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm
(Paper width)
110
System SP2xxx
[1 to 50 / 9 / 1/step]
006 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm
(Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 34 / 1/step]
007 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm
(Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 26 / 1/step]
008 Paper Transfer: Low : 2nd:S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm 3
(Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 10 / 1/step]
009 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S3 size > 194 mm
(Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step]
010 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S3 size > 194 mm
(Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 12 / 1/step]
011 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S3 size > 194 mm
(Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step]
012 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd:S3 *ENG 250 mm > S3 size > 194 mm
(Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 10 / 1/step]
013 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm
(Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step]
014 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm
(Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 35 / 1/step]
015 Paper Transfer: LowSpeed: 1st Side: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm
(Paper width)
111
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step]
016 Paper Transfer: Low: 2nd Side: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm
(Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step]
017 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step]
018 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
3 [1 to 50 / 41 / 1/step]
019 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step]
020 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[Pain-T:Size-Env.Correct:FC] DFU
2414 Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
003 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S1 *ENG S1 size > 290 mm (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 37 / 1/step]
005 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 16 / 1/step]
006 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 32 / 1/step]
007 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
112
System SP2xxx
[1 to 50 / 24 / 1/step]
008 Paper Transfer: Low : 2nd:S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 36 / 1/step]
009 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S3 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 9 / 1/step]
010 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S3 size > 194 mm (Paper 3
width)
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step]
011 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S3 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 18 / 1/step]
012 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd:S3 *ENG 250 mm > S3 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step]
013 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 7 / 1/step]
014 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 22 / 1/step]
015 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 4 / 1/step]
016 Paper Transfer: Low: 2st: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 12 / 1/step]
017 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 7 / 1/step]
018 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
113
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[1 to 50 / 27 / 1/step]
019 Paper Transfer: Low: 1st: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 4 / 1/step]
020 Paper Transfer: Low 2nd: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
3 mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
2421
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
2422 Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
114
System SP2xxx
Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
2423 edge in each mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
2424 Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
115
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2453 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
2457 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in full color mode.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
2471 mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
2472 Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
116
System SP2xxx
Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
2473 edge in each mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec 3
2474 Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
117
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2502 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in black-and-white mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
2507 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in full color mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
118
System SP2xxx
[Thick-T:Size Correct:BW]
2511 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
[Thick-T:Size Correct:FC]
2512 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
119
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Thick:Size-Env.Correct:BW] DFU
2513 Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step]
001 Paper Transfer: 1st: S1 *ENG
S1 size > 290 mm (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 36 / 1/step]
005 Paper Transfer: 1st: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
120
System SP2xxx
[1 to 50 / 40 / 1/step]
009 Paper Transfer: 1st: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S3 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 27 / 1/step]
013 Paper Transfer: 1st: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[Thick:Size-Env.Correct:FC] DFU
2514 Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step]
001 Paper Transfer: 1st: S1 *ENG
S1 size > 290 mm (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 49 / 1/step]
005 Paper Transfer: 1st: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 50 / 1/step]
009 Paper Transfer: 1st: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S3 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 35 / 1/step]
013 Paper Transfer: 1st: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
121
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[1 to 50 / 6 / 1/step]
017 Paper Transfer: 1st: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
2522 Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
2523 edge in each mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
122
System SP2xxx
2524 Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
2553 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick2 paper in black-and-white mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
2558 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick2 paper in full color mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
123
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
2571 mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
2572 Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
2573 mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
2574 Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
124
System SP2xxx
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
2621
mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
125
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
2623
mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
002 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st *ENG [1 to 50 / NA: 39, EU/AA: 26 / 1 /step]
2651 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in black-and-white mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
2652 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in full color mode.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
126
System SP2xxx
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
2654 mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
2655 Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
2656 mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
2657 Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Thick: 60 mm/sec
127
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for middle thick in black-and-white mode.
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for middle thick in full color mode.
128
System SP2xxx
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
2721
mode. SP2703 and SP2707 are multiplied by these SP values.
[M-Thick:SwTiming:L-Edge] DFU
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
2722
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
2723
mode. SP2703 and SP2707 are multiplied by these SP values.
129
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[M-Thick:SwTiming:T-Edge] DFU
3 2724
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
2753 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
130
System SP2xxx
2757 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in full color mode. 3
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
[SP1,2,3-T:Size Correct:BW]
2761 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
002 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S1 *ENG [100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step]
131
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
132
System SP2xxx
[SP1,2,3-T:Size Correct:FC]
3
2762 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
002 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S1 *ENG [100 to 4000 / 100 / 5%/step]
133
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
134
System SP2xxx
2763 Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
[1 to 50 / 23 / 1/step]
005 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 9 / 1/step]
006 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 34 / 1/step]
007 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 26 / 1/step]
008 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 10 / 1/step]
009 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S2 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step]
010 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S2 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 12 / 1/step]
011 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S3 *ENG 250 mm > S2 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
135
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step]
012 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S3 *ENG 250 mm > S2 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 10 / 1/step]
013 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step]
3 014 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 35 / 1/step]
015 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step]
016 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step]
017 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 15 / 1/step]
018 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 41 / 1/step]
019 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 13 / 1/step]
020 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
2764 Adjusts the size correction coefficient table for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
136
System SP2xxx
[1 to 50 / 37 / 1/step]
005 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width) 3
[1 to 50 / 16 / 1/step]
006 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 32 / 1/step]
007 Paper Transfer:Low:1st:S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 24 / 1/step]
008 Paper Transfer:Low:2nd:S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 36 / 1/step]
009 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S2 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 9 / 1/step]
010 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S2 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step]
011 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S3 *ENG 250 mm > S2 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 18 / 1/step]
012 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S3 *ENG 250 mm > S2 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 29 / 1/step]
013 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
137
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[1 to 50 / 7 / 1/step]
014 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 22 / 1/step]
015 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 4 / 1/step]
3 016 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 12 / 1/step]
017 Paper Transfer: Normal: 1st: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 7 / 1/step]
018 Paper Transfer: Normal: 2nd: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 27 / 1/step]
019 PaperTransfer:Low:1st:S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 4 / 1/step]
020 PaperTransfer:Low:2nd:S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
2771 mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
138
System SP2xxx
2772 Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
2773 mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 60 mm/sec
2774 Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
139
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[SP4,5,6-T:Size Correct:BW]
2791 Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values.
140
System SP2xxx
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step]
001 Paper Transfer: S1 *ENG
S1 size > 290 mm (Paper width)
141
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[1 to 50 / 36 / 1/step]
005 Paper Transfer: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 40 / 1/step]
009 Paper Transfer: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S2 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 27 / 1/step]
3 013 Paper Transfer: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 20 / 1/step]
017 Paper Transfer: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 30 / 1/step]
001 Paper Transfer: S1 *ENG
S1 size > 290 mm (Paper width)
[1 to 50 / 49 / 1/step]
005 Paper Transfer: S2 *ENG 290 mm > S2 size > 250 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 50 / 1/step]
009 Paper Transfer: S3 *ENG 250 mm > S2 size > 194 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 35 / 1/step]
013 Paper Transfer: S4 *ENG 194 mm > S4 size > 150 mm (Paper
width)
[1 to 50 / 6 / 1/step]
017 Paper Transfer: S5 *ENG
150 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
142
System SP2xxx
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
2795
mode. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values.
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
2797
mode. SP2783 and SP2787 are multiplied by these SP values.
143
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2803 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
2807 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in full color mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
2821 mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
144
System SP2xxx
2822 Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
2823 mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
2824 Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
145
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
2845
mode. SP2833 and SP2837 are multiplied by these SP values.
146
System SP2xxx
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
3
2847
mode. SP2833 and SP2837 are multiplied by these SP values.
2852 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in black-and-white mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
147
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
2857 Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in full color mode.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
2871 mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
2872 Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
148
System SP2xxx
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
2873 mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
2874 Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Normal: 120mm/sec, Low: 60mm/sec
149
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3
[SP 6: Bias: FC]
2887
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 6 in full color mode.
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
2895
mode. SP2883 and SP2887 are multiplied by these SP values.
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
2897
mode. SP2883 and SP2887 are multiplied by these SP values.
150
System SP2xxx
[Fus.Reload:DrumIdleTimeOffset] DFU
2901 Adjusts the drum idling time for each coverage at the re-load temperature in the half speed
mode.
151
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
006 K *ENG
007 C *ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1/step]
008 M *ENG
3
009 Y *ENG
[ImageTrunsferRevTime] DFU
2904
Adjusts the time for how long the image transfer belt motor reverses after job end.
[GainAdj:TransferM] DFU
2908
Gain Adjustment of Image Transfer Belt Motor
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001 120 mm/sec *ENG 0: GAIN: High speed
1: GAIN: Low speed
152
System SP2xxx
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
002 60 mm/sec *ENG 0: GAIN: High speed
1: GAIN: Low speed
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001 120 mm/sec *ENG 0: GAIN: High speed
1: GAIN: Low speed 3
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
002 60 mm/sec *ENG 0: GAIN: High speed
1: GAIN: Low speed
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001 120 mm/sec *ENG 0: GAIN: High speed
1: GAIN: Low speed
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
002 60 mm/sec *ENG 0: GAIN: High speed
1: GAIN: Low speed
DFU
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
001 TransferMotorCtrl *ENG
0: FG Control
1: ENC Control
153
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
If a horizontal white band at 40 mm from the leading edge occurs in the low speed mode,
002 change this setting from "-80" to "-500".
[Side Effect]:
"580 msec" is added to the first copy/ print time when using the low speed mode.
154
System SP2xxx
001 Specifies the threshold pages for the forced processing stop at a continuous printing job.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
Duty Control State *ENG
001 0: No limit, 1: Limit
Limit or does not limit the duty control for a continuous printing job.
003 Specifies the threshold for the duty control for a continuous printing job.
155
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Drum Stop Time: Duty Control *ENG [300 to 1500 / 1500 / 10 msec/step]
008
Specifies the drum brake time with the duty limit.
ITB Stop Time: Duty Control *ENG [300 to 1500 / 1500 / 10 msec/step]
009
Specifies the ITB brake time with the duty limit.
156
System SP3xxx
System SP3xxx
SP3-XXX (Process)
3012 All colors are displayed. The results are displayed in the order "Y C M K"
e.g., 11 (Y) 99 (C) 11 (M) 11 (K): The self-check for Cyan failed but the others were
successful.
See the "Error Condition Tables" in the Process Control Error section for details.
157
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
005 Execution: M -
006 Execution: Y -
3014 [TD Sen Initial Set Result] Developer Initialization Result: Display
[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step ]
Display: YMCK *ENG 1: Success
2 to 9: Failure
001 Displays the developer initialization result. See the "Error Condition Tables" in the Process
Control Error section for details on the meaning of each code.
All colors are displayed. Values are displayed in the order Y M C Bk.
e.g., 1 (Y) 1 (M) 2 (C) 1 (Bk): Initialization of Cyan failed but the others succeeded.
158
System SP3xxx
005 Execution: M -
3
006 Execution: Y -
001-
DFU
005
159
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
009 Upper Counter: Y *ENG Displays the total times of the Vt upper or lower
limit error.
010 Lower Counter: Bk *ENG [0 to 99 / 0 / 1 times/step]
011 Lower Counter: C *ENG
3
012 Lower Counter: M *ENG
005-
Sets the execution flag of the developer initialization for each color.
008
160
System SP3xxx
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step ] Alphanumeric 3
0: FIXED (Use the fixed values for the charge DC bias
Bias Control *ENG and development DC bias set with SP2-005 and
001 SP2-229.)
1: CONTROL
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step] Alphanumeric
LD Power Control *ENG 0: FIXED (at the value in SP2221-xxx)
002
1: CONTROL (adjusted by process control)
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] Alphanumeric
AutoControl Prohibition
*ENG 0: Permit
003 Set
1: Forbid
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
0: Not Execute
Pre-ACC Process Control *ENG
004 1: Process Control
2: TC Control
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
0: FIXED
005 P-Pattern Selection *ENG
1: INITIALIZED
2: CALCULATED
161
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at power on.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
001 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
3 6 to 9: Disabled
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at the developer
initialization.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
002
4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment in stand by mode.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
003 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at ACC.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
004 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
162
System SP3xxx
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at job end.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
006 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
3
6 to 9: Disabled
163
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
018
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-001) exceed the target values (SP3611-005) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
019
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-002) exceed the target values (SP3611-006) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
020
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-003) exceed the target values (SP3611-007) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
021
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-004) exceed the target values (SP3611-008) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
164
System SP3xxx
004 Y *ENG
3: MBD (Vtref_Fixed)
4: MBD (Vtref_Control)
3
DFU
001 ON/OFF *ENG [0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Detect, 1: Not Detect
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
002 NE Detection *ENG 0: ALL (Calculation and TE sensor)
1: TE Sensor
165
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Displays the remaining amount of each color toner. These are calculated by the operating
009-012
times of the toner supply pumps.
3 Adjusts the threshold of toner near end for each color. The toner near end message appears
on the LCD when the remaining toner amount reaches this threshold. When one of these
013-016
SPs (SP3-101-009 to 012 or -032 to -035) reaches this threshold, toner near end is
detected.
021 This SP is the threshold for toner end. Delta Vt: Vt-Vtref
When both this SP and SP3-101-026 occur at same time, toner end is determined.
Displays the total delta Vt (Vt-Vtref) value for each color.These are calculated by pixel
022-025
counting.
028-031 Displays the consumed toner amount calculated with the pixel count for each color.
166
System SP3xxx
032-035 Displays the remaining toner amount for each color, using pixel count.
050-053 Adjusts the threshold of the remaining toner for the toner near-end detection. DFU
167
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3 3102 Adjusts the number of times toner supply is attempted for each color when the TD sensor
continues to detect toner end during toner recovery.
001 Bk *ENG
002 C *ENG
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 time/step]
003 M *ENG
004 Y *ENG
168
System SP3xxx
[Vtcnt: Display/Set]
3221
Displays or adjusts the current Vtcnt value for each color.
005-
Displays or adjusts the Vtcnt value for each color at developer initialization.
008
169
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Vtcnt: Display/Set]
3222
3 Displays or adjusts the current Vtref value for each color.
005-
Displays or adjusts the Vtref value for each color at developer initialization.
008
009-
Displays or adjusts Vtref correction by pixel coverage for each color.
012
170
System SP3xxx
171
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
017 High Coverage: Threshold:H *ENG Adjusts the threshold of the high
coverage.
018 High Coverage: Threshold:L *ENG [0 to 100 / 20 / 1 %/step]
172
System SP3xxx
173
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
174
System SP3xxx
175
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
176
System SP3xxx
177
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3
3235 [Toner Supply Coeff.: Display] DFU
178
System SP3xxx
001 Bk *ENG 3
002 C *ENG
[0 to 5 / 2.7 / 0.01 V/step]
003 M *ENG
004 Y *ENG
013-014 Threshold for image density rank on the image transfer belt.
179
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Coefficient: Bk *ENG These are parameters for calculating the charge
bias referring to the development bias at process
002 Coefficient: C *ENG control.
3 003 Coefficient: M *ENG [-1000 to 1000 / 0 / 1 /step]
DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 + 0.001
004 Coefficient: Y *ENG x these vales) + SP3-241-005 to -008
005 Offset: Bk *ENG These are additional values for calculating the
charge bias referring to the development bias at
006 Offset: C *ENG process control.
007 Offset: M *ENG [0 to 255 / 140 / 1 V/step]
DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 + 0.001
008 Offset: Y *ENG x SP3-241-001 to -004) + these values
180
System SP3xxx
[DevBias_SpdCorrectSetting]
3243
Adjusts the coefficient or offset value for development bias correction for each speed.
[Coverage]
3251
These (-001 to -016) are coefficients for SP3-222-009 to -012.
002 Latest: Pixcel C *ENG Displays the latest coverage for each color.
181
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
005-008 "Average S" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-017.
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
009-012 "Average M" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-018.
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
013-016 "Average L" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3-251-019.
182
System SP3xxx
005-007 Displays the ID sensor (diffusion) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments.
183
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
184
System SP3xxx
185
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
009 K5 Approximate Method *ENG
0:Linear, 1: Curve
011 K2: Upper Limit Correction *ENG [0.2 to 0.4 / 0.07 / 0.01 /step]
3 012 K2: Lower Limit Correction *ENG [0.2 to 0.4 / 0.07 / 0.01 /step]
186
System SP3xxx
006 Color Correct Coeff.:C *ENG [0.5 to 2.0 / 0.95 / 0.01 /step]
008 Color Correct Coeff.:Y *ENG [0.5 to 2.0 / 1.01 / 0.01 /step]
002 Upper Limit: C *ENG Adjusts the toner supply rate during printing.
187
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
006 Minimum Supply Time: C *ENG Adjusts the minimum toner supply time.
3 001 Bk *ENG
002 C *ENG Displays the toner supply time carried over from
a previous toner supply mode for each color.
003 M *ENG [0 to 10000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]
004 Y *ENG
002 Maximum: C *ENG Adjusts the maximum time carried over from a
previous toner supply mode.
003 Maximum: M *ENG [0 to 10000 / 1000 / 1 msec/step]
004 Maximum: Y *ENG
188
System SP3xxx
189
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3513 Displays the last time that the PCU motors stopped.
These are used for process control execution timing.
190
System SP3xxx
[Refresh Mode]
While making prints with low coverage, the developer is agitated with less toner consumption
3516 and the toner carrier attraction tends to increase. This may cause low image density or poor
transfer (white dots). To prevent this, the coagulated toner or overcharged toner has to be
consumed by performing the refresh mode.
191
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
192
System SP3xxx
3517 Adjusts the threshold temperature for preventing the cleaning blade in the transfer belt
cleaning unit from being damaged. If the temperature is above this value, toner is applied
to the transfer belt at set intervals during the job to prevent the blade from flipping over. 3
001 Execution Temp. Thresh *ENG [0 to 50 / 40 / 1C/step]
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
007 Process Control *ENG
0: OFF. 1: ON (once), 2: ON (twice)
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
008 MUSIC *ENG
0: OFF. 1: ON (once), 2: ON (twice)
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
Sets "1", when the following values shows.
012 Vsg Average Error *ENG Vsg_reg_ave:
3.5 < Vsg_reg_ave < 4.5 or Vsg_dif_ave:
0.0 < Vsg_dif_ave < 0.5
193
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
002 Temperature: Medium *ENG Specifies the idle rotation times of the ITB
after the process control.
003 Temperature: Low *ENG [0 or 3 / 0 / 1 revolution/step]
004 Temp.: L: Power ON *ENG
005 to
Adjusts the threshold temperature for entering the ITB idle rotation after the process control.
011
194
System SP3xxx
[Rapi Timer]
195
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Vk Display]
3612
Displays Vk for each color.
001 Bk *ENG
002 C *ENG
[-300 to 300 / - / 1 V/step]
003 M *ENG
004 Y *ENG
196
System SP3xxx
[Dev. DC Control:Display]
Normal: 120 mm/sec, Low: 70 mm/sec
3621
Displays the development DC bias adjusted with the process control for each line speed and
color.
197
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
198
System SP3xxx
Selects the toner concentration control method by HST memory, which is in the TD sensor.
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
001 Control Selection *ENG
0: Not Use, 1: Use
[HST Control: C]
3712
Displays the factory settings of the magenta PCU.
199
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[HST Control: M]
3713
Displays the factory settings of the cyan PCU.
200
System SP3xxx
[HST Control:Y]
3714
Displays the factory settings of the yellow PCU.
201
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Displays the current condition of the PCDU toner collection bottle.
Not used
3 002 Detection Times *CTL
[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]
Not used
003 Print Page AF Near Full *CTL
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
Not used
004 Pixel Count AF Near Full *CTL
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
Not used
Displays the pixel counter after replacement of
005 Pixel Count AF Replacement *CTL
toner collection bottle.
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
012 Sets the threshold days for the near-full display. The near-full of the PCDU toner collection
bottle is displayed after the toner collection full sensor has detected the actuator in the PCDU
toner collection bottle.
202
System SP3xxx
Not used
002 Detection Times *CTL
[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]
Not used
003 Print Page AF Near Full *CTL
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
Not used
004 Pixel Count AF Near Full *CTL
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
Not used
Displays the pixel counter after replacement of
005 Pixel Count AF Replacement *CTL
toner collection bottle.
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
203
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
012 Sets the threshold days for the near-full display. The near-full of the IT toner collection bottle
is displayed after the toner collection full sensor has detected the actuator in the ITB toner
collection bottle.
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
001 ON/OFF Setting *ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
3902 Turns the new unit detection flag for each PM unit on or off.
The use of these counters is explained in the PM section and in the relevant parts of section
3 (Replacement and Adjustment).
204
System SP3xxx
205
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
011-
Counter 11 to 40 *ENG
040
101 Last Fixed Date *ENG Displays the time of the latest stored counter.
206
System SP4xxx
System SP4xxx
SP4-XXX (Scanner)
207
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
4013 Performs the scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off in the following mode.
Full color mode / Full Size / A3 or DLT
3 4014
[Scan]
208
System SP4xxx
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Normal Detection (the machine detects A4/LT
size as A4 or LT, depending on the paper size
4305 [8K/16K Detection] *ENG setting)
1: A4-Sideways LT-Lengthwise
2: LT-Sideways A4-Lengthwise
3: 8K 16K
001 This program enables the machine to automatically recognize the 8K/16K size.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
001 Detect: ON/OFF *ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
209
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 S1:R -
003 S1:B -
004 S2:R -
006 S2:B -
3
007 S3:R -
009 S3:B -
210
System SP4xxx
0: Scanned image
13: Grid pattern CMYK
1: Gradation main scan A
14: Color patch CMYK
2: Gradation main scan B
15: Gray pattern (1)
3: Gradation main scan C
16: Gray pattern (2)
4: Gradation main scan D
17: Gray Pattern (3)
5: Gradation sub scan (1)
18: Shading pattern
6: Grid pattern
19: Thin line pattern
7: Slant grid pattern
20: Scanned + Grid pattern
3
8: Gradation RGBCMYK
21: Scanned + Gray scale
9: UCR pattern
22: Scanned + Color patch
10: Color patch 16 (1)
23: Scanned + Slant Grid C
11: Color patch 16 (2)
24: Scanned + Slant Grid D
12: Color patch 64
001 Copy
003 Fax
[Saturation Adjustment]
4440
Adjusts the level of saturation for copying.
[0 to 5 / 3 / 1 /step]
0: High
1: Lowest
001 - *ENG 2: Lower
3: Default
4: Higher
5: Highest
211
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3 4460 Specifies the level of deleting the background in the ADS mode. You can adjust its level for
each scanning method (platen, ADF).
[ACC Correction:Bright]
4505
Adjusts the offset correction for light areas of the ACC pattern.
212
System SP4xxx
213
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong) *ENG
0: MTF Off
-005
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
214
System SP4xxx
-009 Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong) *ENG
0: MTF Off
-005
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
-009 Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
215
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
-010 Sets the erasure level of textures. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. This
SP (suffix "-010") only exists in SP4580, 4582 and 4583.
0: Not activated
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong) *ENG
0: MTF Off
-005
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
-009 Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
[0 to 0xFF / 0 / 1 /step]
001 SBU ID -
Displays the ID of the SBU.
216
System SP4xxx
217
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
218
System SP4xxx
219
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 Power-ON - 0: OK, Other: SBU connection check failure
If the SBU connection check fails, SC144 occurs.
220
System SP4xxx
221
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
222
System SP4xxx
223
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
4688 Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF.
Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different.
001 RE -
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
002 RO -
001 GE -
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
002 GO -
001 BE -
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
002 BO -
224
System SP4xxx
001 RE -
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
002 RO -
001 BE -
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
002 BO -
001 Lamp OFF Executes the scanner free run of shading movement
with exposure lamp on or off.
-
002 Lamp ON Press "OFF" to stop this free run. Otherwise, the free
run lasts.
225
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
- - [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
This SP outputs the final data read at the end of ACC execution.
4902
A zero is returned if there was an error reading the data.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
226
System SP4xxx
Performs a write and read check of the ASICs on the BCU board and displays the result. 3
Bit0: Image path from SBU to TAURUS
Bit1: Image path from TAURUS to ORION
Bit2: Image path from ORION to TAURUS
Bit3: Image path from TAURUS to LUPUS
Test2 - Bit4 to 11: Not used
002
Bit12: Image path from LUPUS to Ri20
Bit13: Image path from Ri20 to GAVD
Bit14 and 15: Not used
0: OK, 1: Error
Performs an image path check on the BCU board and displays the result.
227
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
004 Set Standard Chart - Restores a new chart data as a standard chart data.
228
System SP4xxx
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Text priority
001 High Compression PDF *ENG
1: Normal
2: Photo priority
[0 to 6 / 3 / 1 /step]
001 - *ENG 0: lightest
6: Darkest
229
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
System SP5xxx
SP5-XXX (Mode)
[Accounting Counter]
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 Counter Method *CTL 0: Developments
1: Prints
[Paper Display]
5047
Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 Backing Paper *CTL
0: OFF, 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] Alphanumeric
5051 1 - *CTL 0: ON
1: OFF
[Display IP Address]
5055
Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD.
230
System SP5xxx
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 - *CTL
0: OFF 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 - *CTL
0: Not display, 1: Display
3
[Toner Remaining Icon Display Change]
5061
Display or does not display the remaining toner display icon on the LCD.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 - *CTL
0: Not display, 1: Display
231
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
- *CTL
001 0: Normal Tray, 1: Envelope Feeder
3 001 - *CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: No Display, 1: Display
5067 Selects the service maintenance or user maintenance for each PM parts.
If the user service is selected, PM alart is displayed on the LCD.
232
System SP5xxx
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
- *CTL
0: Off, 1: On
001
Turn on or off the paper size confirmation pop-up on the LED. This pop-up prevents
mismatching between a paper size selected by the operation panel and an actual paper
size on the by-pass tray.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step] 3
0: No
PCU:Bk *CTL
1: Yes
001 2: Yes except By-pass
Specifies whether the counter is doubled for A3/DLT. "Yes" counts except from the bypass
tray. When "Yes" is selected, A3 and DLT paper are counted twice, that is A4 x2 and LT x2
respectively.
233
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Mode Clear Opt. Counter [0: Yes (removed)/ 1: Standby (installed but not
5120 *CTL
Removal] used)/ 2: No (not removed)]
This program updates the information on the optional counter. When you install or remove
001
an optional counter, check the settings.
3
5121 [Counter Up Timing] *CTL [0: Feed/ 1: Exit]
This program specifies when the counter goes up. The settings refer to "paper feed" and
001
"paper exit" respectively.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: 8 1/2" x 13" (Foolscap)
5126 [F Size Original Setting] *ENG
1: 8 1/4" x 13" (Folio)
2: 8" x 13" (F)
001 DFU
DFU
5131 [Paper Size Type Selection] *ENG
[0: JP (Japan)/ 1: NA / 2: EU]
The program selects a paper size system from the following alternatives: the AB system (0),
001
the LT system (1), and the AF system (2).
234
System SP5xxx
Determines whether the transfer sheet from the by-pass tray is used or not.
001 Normally the paper length for sub scanning paper from the by-pass tray is limited to 600
mm, but this can be extended with this SP to 1260 mm.
5162 [App. Switch Method] *CTL [0: Soft Key Set/ 1: Hard Key Set]
001 This program specifies the switch that selects an application program.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
Fax Printing Mode at Optional
001 *CTL 0: Automatic printing
Counter Off
1: No automatic printing
[CE Login]
5169 If you will change the printer bit switches, you must log in to service mode with this SP before
you go into the printer SP mode.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 - *CTL 0: Disabled
1: Enabled
[Size Adjust]
5181
Adjusts the paper size for each tray.
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
002 Tray 1: 2 *ENG
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
003 Tray 1: 3 *ENG
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
004 Tray 1: 4 *ENG
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
235
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
005 Tray 2: 1 *ENG
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
006 Tray 2: 2 *ENG
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
007 Tray 2: 3 *ENG
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
009 Tray 3: 1 *ENG
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
010 Tray 3: 2 *ENG
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
011 Tray 3: 3 *ENG
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
012 Tray 3: 4 *ENG
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 to 2 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
013 Tray 4: 1 *ENG
0: A4LEF, 1: LTLEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
014 Tray 4: 2 *ENG
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
015 Tray 4: 3 *ENG
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
016 Tray 4: 4 *ENG
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
5186 Enables or disables the prevention for RK4 (accounting device) disconnection.
If the RK4 is disconnected for 10 seconds when this SP is set to "1 (Enable)", the machine
automatically jams a sheet of paper and stops.
236
System SP5xxx
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001 - *ENG 0: Disable
1: Enable
[Copy NV Version]
5188
Displays the version number of the NVRAM on the controller board.
001 - *CTL -
3
5195 [Limitless SW] DFU
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
- *CTL 0: Productivity priority
1: Tray priority
[ 0 or 1 / 0 / -]
001 - *CTL
0: OFF, 1: ON
237
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Enables or disables the paper feeding out from the finisher without stapling.
If this setting is "1: ON", paper is fed out without stapling at the maximum number of
the finisher stapling when the machine gets a multiple printing job (over maximum
number).
If this setting is "0: OFF", paper is fed out with stapling at the maximum number of the
finisher stapling when the machine gets a multiple printing job (over maximum number).
[Set Time]
Adjusts the RTC (real time clock) time setting for the local time zone.
Examples: For Japan (+9 GMT), enter 540 (9 hours x 60 min.)
DOM: +540 (Tokyo)
5302 NA: -300 (New York)
EU: + 60 (Paris)
CH: +480 (Peking)
TW: +480 (Taipei)
AS: +480 (Hong Kong)
238
System SP5xxx
Make sure that both SP5-307-3 and -4 are correctly set. Otherwise, this SP is not
activated even if this SP is set to "1". 3
Rule Set (Start) -
239
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Access Control]
5401
When installing the SDK application, SAS (VAS) adjusts the following settings. DFU
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 sec./step]
Authentication Time *CTL 0: 60 seconds
104
1 to 250 seconds
210 SDK2 Unique ID *CTL "SDK" is the "Software Development Kit". This
data can be converted from SAS (VAS) when
211 SDK2 Certification Method *CTL installed or uninstalled. (DFU)
240
System SP5xxx
241
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
242
System SP5xxx
243
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[User Authentication]
5420
3 These settings should be done with the System Administrator.
Note: These functions are enabled only after the user access feature has been enabled.
Enables or disables the color copy limitation for each copy mode when the user
authentication is "ON".
0: Enable (default), 1: Disable
Bit0: B/W mode
002
Bit1: Mono color mode
Bit2: Two colors mode
Bit3: Full color mode
Bit4: Automatic color mode
Bit5 to 7: Reserved
244
System SP5xxx
003 Message Text ID *CTL Inputs message text for the authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
Tag *CTL
010 0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the tag copy permission for the external authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
Entry *CTL
011 0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the entry information for the external authentication.
245
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
Group *CTL
012 0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the group information for the external authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
Mail *CTL
020 0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the mail information for the external authentication.
3 Fax *CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
Turns on or off the copy permission of the fax information for the external authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
FaxSub *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
031
Turns on or off the copy permission of the fax additional information for the external
authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
Folder *CTL
032 0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the folder information for the external authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
ProtectCode *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
033
Turns on or off the copy permission of the protection code information for the external
authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
SmtpAuth *CTL
034 0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the SMTP information for the external authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
LdapAuth *CTL
035 0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the LDAP information for the external authentication.
246
System SP5xxx
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
Smb Ftp Auth *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
036
Turns on or off the copy permission of the SMB/FTP information for the external
authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
AcntAcl *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
037
Turns on or off the copy permission of the account ACL information for the external
authentication.
3
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
DocumentAcl *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
038
Turns on or off the copy permission of the document ACL information for the external
authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
CertCrypt
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
040
Turns on or off the copy permission of the authentication information for the external
authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
UserLimitCount *CTL
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
050
Turns on or off the copy permission of the maximum number information for the external
authentication.
247
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Job Permit Setting *CTL 0: Disabled. Cancels operation without a user
code.
1: Enabled. Allows operation without a user
code.
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 / step]
0: Alarm off
001 PM Alarm Level *CTL
1 to 9999: Alarm goes off when Value (1 to
9999) x 1000 > PM counter
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: No alarm sounds
002 Original Count Alarm *CTL
1: Alarm sounds after the number of originals
passing through the ARDF > 10,000
Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included).
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
0: Zero (Off)
001
1: Low (2.5K jams)
2: Medium (3K jams)
3: High (6K jams)
248
System SP5xxx
[Error Alarm]
249
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[SC/Alarm Setting]
5515 With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an SC call when an SC error
occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC call is not issued when an SC error occurs.
001 SC Call
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
002 Service Parts Near End Call
0: Off
003 Service Parts End Call
1: On
004 User Call
250
System SP5xxx
Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
251
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
3 G-Y *ENG
[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: ACS, Colour, Black & White, Two Colour, Single
- *CTL
001 colour
1: ACD, Full Colour, Black & White
252
System SP5xxx
Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX settings,
007 Fax application
local storage file numbers, and off-hook timer.
Initializes the scanner defaults for the scanner and all the
009 Scanner application
scanner SP modes.
253
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
014 Clear DCS Setting Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control Service) settings.
018 SRM Memory Clr Initializes the SRM (System Resource Manager) settings.
004 EXE.ALL - Execute the RFID communication test for all colors.
254
System SP5xxx
[SC Reset]
005 FRAM
Service *CTL -
001 Sets the telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List, which can be printed with the users "Counter" menu.
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Facsimile *CTL -
002 Sets the fax or telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List.
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Supply *CTL -
003 Use this to input the telephone number of your supplier for consumables. Enter the number
and press #.
255
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Operation *CTL -
004 Use this to input the telephone number of your sales agency. Enter the number and press
#.
I/F Setting
CE Call
Function Flag
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
NOTE: This SP setting is changed to "1" after @Remote registor has been completed.
SSL Disable
Uses or does not use the RCG certification by SSL when calling the RCG.
007 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
008 Specifies the connect timeout interval when calling the RCG.
[1 to 90 / 10 / 1 second /step]
256
System SP5xxx
009 Specifies the write timeout interval when calling the RCG.
010 Specifies the read timeout interval when calling the RCG.
Port 80 Enable 3
Enables/disables access via port 80 to the SOAP method.
011
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
RCG C Registed
0: Internet connection
1: Dial-up connection
257
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Use Proxy
062 This SP setting determines if the proxy server is used when the machine communicates with
the service center.
Proxy Host
3 This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication between Embedded
RC Gate-N and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or display the customer proxy server
address. The address is necessary to set up Embedded RC Gate-N.
063
The address display is limited to 128 characters. Characters beyond the 128
character are ignored.
This address is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication between Embedded
064 RC Gate-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to set up Embedded RC Gate-N.
This port number is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
065
The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy Password
066
The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
258
System SP5xxx
CERT: Up State
067
Displays the status of the certification update.
The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received from the GW
1
URL and certification is presently being updated.
The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
2
successful update.
3
3 The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failed update.
The period of the certification has expired and new request for an update is being
4
sent to the GW URL.
A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue certification setting
11
is in progress for the rescue GW connection.
The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
12
certification update request.
The notification of the request for certification update has completed successfully,
13 and the system is waiting for the certification update request from the rescue GW
URL.
The notification of the certification request has been received from the rescue GW
14
controller, and the certification is being stored.
The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of the successful
15
completion of this event.
The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the
16
failure of this event.
The certification update request has been received from the GW URL, the GW URL
17 was notified of the results of the update after it was completed, but a certification
error has been received, and the rescue certification is being recorded.
The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL is being
18
notified of the failure of the certification update.
CERT: Error
068 Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update of the
certification.
259
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
1 Request for certification update in progress. The current certification has expired.
2 An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification has expired.
087 CERT: Macro Ver. Displays the macro version of the @Remote certification.
088 CERT: PAC Ver. Displays the PAC version of the @Remote certification.
260
System SP5xxx
Displays the start time of the period for which the current
093 CERT: Valid Start
@Remote certification is enabled.
Displays the end time of the period for which the current
094 CERT: Valid End
@Remote certification is enabled.
150
Selection Country 3
Not used
Selection Dial/Push
153
Not used
Dial Up Password
157
Not used
Access Point
163
Not used
261
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Line Connecting
164
Not used
Retransmission Limit
174
Not used
FAX TX Priority -
3 187
Not used
Regist: Status
Displays a number that indicates the status of the @Remote service device.
0: Neither the @Remote device nor Embedded RCG Gate is set.
1: The Embedded RCG Gate is being set. Only Box registration is completed. In this status,
201 @Remote device cannot communicate with this device.
2: The Embedded RCG Gate is set. In this status, the @Remote device cannot communicate
with this device.
3: The @Remote device is being set. In this status the Embedded RCG Gate cannot be set.
4: The @Remote module has not started.
203 Confirm Execute Executes the confirmation request to the @Remote Gateway.
262
System SP5xxx
Displays a number that indicates the result of the confirmation executed with SP5816-203.
0: Succeeded
1: Confirmation number error
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
6: Communication error 3
7: Certification update error
8: Other error
9: Confirmation executing
Confirm Place
205 Displays the result of the notification sent to the device from the Gateway in answer to the
confirmation request. Displayed only when the result is registered at the Gateway.
Register Result
Error Code
208 Displays a number that describes the error code that was issued when either SP5816-204
or SP5816-207 was executed.
263
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
264
System SP5xxx
5824 Uploads the UP and SP mode data (except for counters and the serial number) from the
NVRAM to an SD card. For details, see the "NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the
"System Maintenance Reference" of the Field Service Manual.
001 - # -
5825 Downloads the UP and SP mode data from an SD card to the NVRAM. For details, see the
"NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the "System Maintenance Reference" of the Field
Service Manual.
001 - # -
265
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
266
System SP5xxx
267
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
268
System SP5xxx
072 Reduction for Copy B&W Text 0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4
073 Reduction for Copy B&W Other 0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4
269
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
081 Format for Copy Color
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
082 Format for Copy B&W Text
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
083 Format for Copy B&W Other
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
084 Format for Printer Color
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
085 Format for Printer B&W
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
086 Format for Printer B&W HQ
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
091 Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document management server via
the MLB with JPEG selected as the format.
Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed.
270
System SP5xxx
102 Primary srv scheme This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
103 Primary srv port number This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
104 Primary srv URL path This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
113 Secondary srv port number This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
114 Secondary srv URL path This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
120 Default Reso Rate Switch This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
121 Selects the resolution for color copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
122 Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
271
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
125 [0 to 6 / 4 / 1/step]
Selects the resolution for color fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
Selects the resolution for BW fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
All Addr Info Switch
141 0: Off, 1: On
Turns on or off the all address information transmission for the captured resources.
272
System SP5xxx
[1 to 11 or 13 / 11 or 13 / 1 /step]
Channel MAX *CTL Europe/Asia: 1 to 13
NA/ Asia: 1 to 11
Sets the maximum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
006 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the maximum end of the range for each area. Adjust the upper 4 bits to set the maximum
number of channels. DFU
3
Do not change the setting.
[1 to 11 or 13 / 1 / 1 /step]
Channel MIN *CTL Europe: 1 to 13
NA/ Asia: 1 to 11
Sets the minimum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
007 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the minimum end of the range for each area. Adjust the lower 4 bits to set the minimum
number of channels. DFU
[0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -]
0 x FF to Auto [Default]
0 x 11 55M Fix
0 x 10 48M Fix
0 x 0F 36M Fix
0 x 0E 18M Fix
0 x 0D 12M Fix
008 Transmission Speed *CTL 0 x 0B 9M Fix
0 x 0A 6M Fix
0 x 07 11M Fix
0 x 05 5.5M Fix
0 x 08 1M Fix
0 x 13 0 x FE (reserved)
0 x 12 72M (reserved)
0 x 09 22M (reserved)
273
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
274
System SP5xxx
5844 [USB]
275
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
Notify Unsupport *CTL
100 0: Disable, 1: Enable
3 5845
[Delivery Server Setting] *CTL -
006 Use this setting to determine the length of time the prompt message is displayed when a
test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and an external
device.
008 Specifies the IP address assigned to the computer designated to function as the secondary
delivery server of Scan Router. This SP allows only the setting of the IP address without
reference to the DNS setting.
Allows changing the model of the delivery server registered by the I/O device.
0: Unknown
009 1: SG1 Provided
2: SG1 Package
3: SG2 Provided
4: SG2 Package
276
System SP5xxx
Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered.
Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered.
011
Bit7 = 1 Address book usage limitation (Limitation for each authorized user)
Bit6 = 1 RDH authorization link
Bit5 to 0: Not used
277
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending error.
022
[0 to 1 / 0 / -]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
3
5846 [UCS Settings] *CTL -
001 Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The value is only
displayed and cannot be changed. This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394
EUI. The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary.
002 Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer directory. Execute
this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery server is unstable. After clearing the
ID, the ID will be established again automatically by cycling the machine off and on.
003 Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle.
If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is cleared, and the
data (excluding user code information) is displayed.
278
System SP5xxx
This SP must be executed immediately after installation of an HDD unit in a basic machine
that previously had no HDD. The first time the machine is powered on with the new HDD
installed, the system automatically takes the address book from the NVRAM and writes it
onto the new HDD. However, the new address book on the HDD can be accessed only
by the system administrator at this stage. Executing this SP by the service technician
immediately after power on grants full address book access to all users.
Procedure
041
1. Turn the machine off.
2. Install a new HDD.
3. Turn the machine on.
4. The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD automatically.
5. However, at this point the address book can be accessed by only the system
administrator or key operator.
6. Enter the SP mode and do SP5846-041. After this SP executes successfully, any user
can access the address book.
279
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
051 Backup All Addr Book Uploads all directory information to the SD card.
052 Restore All Addr Book Downloads all directory information from the SD card.
Search Option
This SP uses bit switches to set up the fuzzy search options for the UCS local address book.
Bit: Meaning
0: Checks both upper/lower case characters
060
1: Japan Only
2: Japan Only
3: Japan Only
4 to 7: Not Used
280
System SP5xxx
Complexity Option 1
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book.
Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to upper case and sets the length of the
password.
062 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1 /step]
SP5847-1 through SP5847-8 changes the default settings of image data transferred
externally by the Net File page reference function.
5847 [ 0 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step]
SP5847-21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files handled by NetFile.
"Net files" are jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the
DeskTopBinder software.
281
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
0: 1x
1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
006 Rate for Printer Color 1200dpi
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
0: 1x
3 1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
007 Rate for Printer B&W 1200dpi
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
021 Sets the default value for the quality of JPEG images sent as NetFile pages. This function
is available only with the MLB (Media Link Board) option installed.
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]
SP5848-2 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting. Setting of 0001
5848 has no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router.
5848 100 sets the maximum size allowed for downloaded images. The default is equal
to 1 gigabyte.
282
System SP5xxx
283
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
003 The machine is sold ready to use with a G3 line. This SP allows you to switch all at once
to convert to G4 after you add a G4 line. Conversely, if for some reason the G4 line
becomes unusable, you can easily switch back to G3.
[Bluetooth Mode]
5851 Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key.
[0:Public] [1: Private]
Use this SP to download the fixed stamp data stored in the firmware of the ROM and copy
it to the HDD. This SP can be executed as many times as required. This SP must be executed
5853
after replacing or formatting the hard disks.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step]
002 Local Port *CTL 0: Disable
1: Enable
284
System SP5xxx
002 Selects the storage device to save debug logs information when the conditions set with
SP5-858 are satisfied.
[ 2 to 3 / 2 / 1 /step]
3
Save to HDD
Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the HDD.
005
A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on the SD Card.
Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to
each SD Card.
Save to SD Card
006
Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the SD card.
5858 These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to the destination
selected by SP5857-002.
SP5858-3 stores one SC specified by number. Refer to Section 4 for a list of SC error codes.
285
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3 0: OFF, 1: ON
001 Key 1
002 Key 2
003 Key 3
004 Key 4
These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log files for
005 Key 5 functions that use common memory on the controller
board.
006 Key 6
[9999999 to 9999999 / 0 / ]
007 Key 7
008 Key 8
009 Key 9
010 Key 10
286
System SP5xxx
Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during reception. The
received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail is not received during this
prescribed time.
287
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Initialize *CTL -
288
System SP5xxx
289
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
0: OFF, 1: ON
Bit Meaning
0: Forbid all document server access (1)
1: Forbid user mode access (1)
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Signature for each e-mail
Set Signature *CTL
1: Signature for all e-mails
100
2: No signature
Selects whether the signature is added to the scanned documents with the WIM when they
are transmitted by an e-mail.
290
System SP5xxx
001 SDK-1
002 SDK-2
003 SDK-3
004 SDK-4
005 SDK-5
006 SDK-6
291
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play. This information
is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these names should be registered again.
001
After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time. When the setting
is completed, the beeper sounds five times.
3
5913 [Switchover Permission Time]
Enables and disables the document server. This is a security measure that prevents image
001 data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After changing this setting, you must
switch the main switch off and on to enable the new setting.
[Cherry Server]
5974
Specifies which version of ScanRouter, "Lite" or "Full", is installed.
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
001 Cherry Server *CTL
0: Lite, 1: Full
[Device Setting]
5985 The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this SP to enable
and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB functions built into the controller
board, these SP codes must be set to "1".
292
System SP5xxx
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation
When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is
limited only for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication.
001 On Board NIC
293
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
006 Non-Default -
3
007 NIB Summary - -
022 Scanner SP -
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
001 fast/silent -
0: Silent, 1: Fast
294
System SP6xxx
System SP6xxx
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)
Adjusts the side-to-side and leading registration of originals with the ARDF.
Adjusts the amount of paper buckle to correct original skew for the front and rear sides.
295
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
*ENG 0: Setting 1
1: Setting 2
Setting 1 Setting 2
296
System SP6xxx
[Extra Staples]
6830
Not used in this model
297
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
System SP7-xxx
SP7-XXX (Data Log)
[Total SC Counter]
7401
Displays the number of SC codes detected.
[SC History]
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
*CTL -
006 Latest 5
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9
[SC991 History]
298
System SP7-xxx
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
*CTL -
006 Latest 5
3
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9
299
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
300
System SP7-xxx
301
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 At Power On
302
System SP7-xxx
005 A4 LEF
006 A5 LEF
014 B5 LEF
038 LT LEF
132 A3 SEF
3
133 A4 SEF
141 B4 SEF
142 B5 SEF
164 LG SEF
166 LT SEF
255 Others
303
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
*CTL -
006 Latest 5
3
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9
001 Latest
002 Latest-1
003 Latest-2
004 Latest-3
005 Latest-4
*CTL -
006 Latest-5
007 Latest-6
008 Latest-7
009 Latest-8
010 Latest-9
304
System SP7-xxx
Displays the number of sheets printed for each current maintenance unit.
PM counters click up based on the number of A4 (LT) LEF size sheets printed. Therefore,
the A3 (DLT) Double Count is activated. The Double Count cannot be deactivated.
-001 to When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed.
-021 Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous
(SP7-906-1 to 21) and is reset to "0".
The total number of sheets printed with the last unit replaced can be checked with
SP7-906-1 to 21.
001 Paper
305
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
306
System SP7-xxx
Displays the number of revolutions of motors or clutches for each current maintenance unit.
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 revolution/step ]
-031 to When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed.
-048 Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous
(SP7-906-31 to 48) and is reset to "0". The total number of revolutions made with the last
unit replaced can be checked with SP7-906-31 to 48.
307
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
Displays the value given by the following formula:
(Current revolution Target revolution) 100. This shows how much of the units expected
-061 to lifetime has been used up.
-078
The Rotation% counter is based on rotations, not prints. If the number of rotations reaches
the limit, the machine enters the end condition for that unit. If the print count lifetime is
3 reached first, the machine also enters the end condition, even though the R% counter is still
less than 100%.
308
System SP7-xxx
-091 to
lifetime has been used up.
3
-108 The Page% counter is based on printouts, not revolutions. If the number of printouts reaches
the limit, the machine enters the end condition for that unit. If the revolution count lifetime is
reached first, the machine also enters the end condition, even though the Page% counter
is still less than 100%.
309
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 Paper
002 PCU: Bk
003 PCU: C
004 PCU: M
005 PCU: Y
310
System SP7-xxx
012 Developer: Bk
013 Developer: C
014 Developer: M
015 Developer: Y
100 All
001 - *CTL -
- *CTL -
311
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 - *CTL -
001 - *CTL -
7852 Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on the scanning
glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter. Counting is done only if SP4-020-1
(ADF Scan Glass Dust Check) is switched on.
[Replacement Counter]
7853
Displays the PM parts replacement number.
312
System SP7-xxx
313
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Coverage Range]
[Assert Info]
7901 Records the location where a problem is detected in the program. The data stored in this
SP is used for problem analysis. DFU
003 Location
-001 to Displays the number of sheets printed with the previous maintenance units.
-020 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 page/step ]
314
System SP7-xxx
-031 to Displays the number of revolutions for motors or clutches in the previous maintenance units.
-050 [0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]
315
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
-061 to Displays the number of sheets printed with the previous maintenance unit or toner cartridge.
-080 [0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ]
316
System SP7-xxx
317
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
318
System SP7-xxx
[Toner Bottle M]
7932
Displays the toner bottle information for M.
319
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Toner Bottle C]
7933
Displays the toner bottle information for C.
320
System SP7-xxx
[Toner Bottle Y]
7934
Displays the toner bottle information for Y.
321
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
322
System SP7-xxx
323
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
324
System SP7-xxx
325
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
326
System SP7-xxx
327
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
328
System SP7-xxx
Day Threshold:
027 *EGN
Development Unit: M
Day Threshold:
028 *EGN
Development Unit: Y
033 Day Threshold: ITB Unit *EGN These threshold days are used for @Remote
alarms.
Day Threshold: ITB
034 *EGN
Cleaning Unit
329
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3 043
Rotation: Development Unit:
*EGN
C
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
Rotation: Development Unit:
044 *EGN
M
330
System SP7-xxx
062 Day Threshold:PTR Unit Adjusts the threshold day of the near end for each
PM unit.
063 Day Thresh:ITB T-Collect Bttl
*EGN [1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step] 3
Day Thresh:PCU T-Collect These threshold days are used for @Remote
064
Bttl alarms.
001 T<=0
002 0<T<=5:0<=H<30
003 0<T<=5:30<=H<70
331
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
001 -
332
System SP8-xxx
System SP8-xxx
SP8-xxx: Data Log2
Many of these counters are provided for features that are currently not available, such as sending color
faxes, and so on. However, here are some Group 8 codes that when used in combination with others, can
provide useful information.
SP8 401 to SP8 406 The number of pages printed from the document server
SP8 691 to SP8 696 The number of pages sent from the document server
C: Copy application.
F: Fax application. Totals (pages, jobs, etc.) executed for each application when
P: Print application. the job was not stored on the document server.
S: Scan application.
333
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
The Group 8 SP codes are limited to 17 characters, forced by the necessity of displaying them on the small
LCDs of printers and faxes that also use these SPs. Read over the list of abbreviations below and refer to it
again if you see the name of an SP that you do not understand.
Key for Abbreviations
Apl Application
Bk Black
C Cyan
Comb Combine
Comp Compression
Deliv Delivery
334
System SP8-xxx
Emul Emulation
FC Full Color 3
FIN Post-print processing, i.e. finishing (punching, stapling, etc.)
Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does not count
up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts up by the number
GPC
that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page job, the counter counts up
11-10 =1)
Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g. border
ImgEdt
removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc.
K Black (YMCK)
Mag Magnification
Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor: A pair of utilities that allows print jobs
Palm 2 to be distributed evenly among the printers on the network, and allows files
to moved around, combined, and converted to different formats.
335
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
PC Personal Computer
Pages. A page is the total scanned surface of the original. Duplex pages
PGS count as two pages, and A3 simplex count as two pages if the A3/DLT
counter SP is switched ON.
3 Ppr Paper
Red (Toner Remaining). Applies to the wide format model A2 only. This
R
machine is under development and currently not available.
Rez Resolution
Scn Scan
S-to-Email Scan-to-E-mail
SMC report printed with SP5990. All of the Group 8 counters are recorded
SMC
in the SMC report.
Svr Server
All of the Group 8 SPs are reset with SP5 801 1 Memory All Clear.
336
System SP8-xxx
337
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments.
When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments. However,
for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter increments.
When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you enter document
server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments.
When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments.
When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments.
When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments.
When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments.
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C: counter
increments.
When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the document server
with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P: counters both increment.
When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L: counter
increments.
338
System SP8-xxx
When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the S: counter
increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then the L: counter
increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2), are printed
with another application, the O: counter increments.
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web Image
Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments.
When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments.
When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the application
that started the print job is incremented.
When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image Monitor, etc.)
the L: counter increments.
8 041 T:TX Jobs/LS *CTL These SPs count the applications that stored files
on the document server that were later accessed
8 042 C:TX Jobs/LS *CTL for transmission over the telephone line or over a
8 043 F:TX Jobs/LS *CTL network (attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image
by I-Fax).
8 044 P:TX Jobs/LS *CTL [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
8 045 S:TX Jobs/LS *CTL Note: Jobs merged for sending are counted
separately.
8 046 L:TX Jobs/LS *CTL
The L: counter counts the number of jobs scanned
from within the document server mode screen at
8 047 O:TX Jobs/LS *CTL
the operation panel.
When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments.
339
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as an e-
mail, the O: counter increments.
If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O: counter
increments.
8 063 These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method is specified by
the application.
Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time.
8 065 These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method is specified by
the application.
Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time.
340
System SP8-xxx
8 066 These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the document server mode
screen at the operation panel. The finishing method is specified from the print window
within document server mode.
Number of jobs started in Sort mode. When a stored copy job is set for
3
8 06x 1 Sort Sort and then stored on the document server, the L: counter increments.
(See SP8 066 1)
Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set
8 06x 5 Z-Fold
for folding (Z-fold).
Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch is set for a print job,
8 06x 6 Punch
the P: counter increments. (See SP8 064 6.)
341
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
S:Jobs/PGS [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
8 075 These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on the number of
pages in the job.
For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server mode,
the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments.
Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073).
Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job.
If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the time the
error occurs.
For copy jobs (SP 8072) and scan jobs (SP 8075), the total is calculated by multiplying the number
of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.)
The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of pages of the
copy job (SP 8072).
342
System SP8-xxx
When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is counted.
8 111 These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax, either
directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8 113 These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax directly
on a telephone line.
3
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8 11x 1 B/W
8 11x 2 Color
8 121 These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent, either directly
or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8 123 These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not stored on the
document server), as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8 12x 1 B/W
8 12x 2 Color
343
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
The counters for color are provided for future use; the color fax feature is not available at this time.
The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.
3 8 135 These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and attached to
e-mail, without storing the original on the document server.
8 13x 1 B/W
8 13x 2 Color
8 13x 3 ACS
8 14x 1 B/W
8 14x 2 Color
344
System SP8-xxx
8 14x 3 ACS
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent to
8 151 a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC).
Note: At the present time, 8 151 and 8 155 perform identical counts.
8 15x 1 B/W
8 15x 2 Color
8 15x 3 ACS
345
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 161 T:PCFAX TX Jobs *CTL These SPs count the number of PC Fax transmission
jobs. A job is counted from when it is registered for
sending, not when it is sent.
This counts fax jobs started from a PC using a PC fax application, and sending the data out to the
3 destination from the PC through the copier.
8 171 T: Deliv Jobs/WSD *CTL These SPs count the pages scanned by WS.
x 1 B/W
x 2 Color
x 3 ACS
8 181 T: Scan to Media Jobs *CTL These SPs count the scanned pages in a media
by the scanner application.
8 185 S: Scan to Media Jobs *CTL [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
x 1 B/W
x 2 Color
x 3 ACS
SP 8 191 to 8 196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical pages.
These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust color.
Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted.
346
System SP8-xxx
A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned.
Scans made in SP mode are not counted.
Examples
If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored, the S: count
is 4.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store File button
in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6. 3
T:LSize Scan PGS *CTL [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
8 201 These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan and copy
jobs. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
8 203 These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for fax transmission.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
8 205 These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan jobs only.
Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
8 211 T:Scan PGS/LS *CTL These SPs count the number of pages scanned into the
document server .
8 212 C:Scan PGS/LS *CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
8 213 F:Scan PGS/LS *CTL The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
8 215 S:Scan PGS/LS *CTL
operation panel, and with the Store File button from
8 216 L:Scan PGS/LS *CTL within the Copy mode screen
347
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6 and the
L: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1.
If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting. Also, the
pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output.
8 231 2 SADF Selectable. Feeding pages one by one through the ADF.
8 231 3 Mixed Size Selectable. Select "Mixed Sizes" on the operation panel.
348
System SP8-xxx
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode,
the count is done for the last selected mode.
The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the originals
page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted.
If the user selects "Mixed Sizes" for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is enabled.
In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with SADF, the
Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3.
8 246 These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the document server
mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy
mode screen
349
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode,
the count is done for the last selected mode.
8 251 T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt *CTL These SPs show how many times Image Edit features
3 have been selected at the operation panel for each
8 252 C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt *CTL application. Some examples of these editing features
8 255 S:Scan PGS/ImgEdt *CTL are:
Erase> Border
8 256 L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt *CTL
Erase> Center
Image Repeat
Centering
Positive/Negative
8 257 O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt *CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: The count totals the number of times the edit
features have been used. A detailed breakdown of
exactly which features have been used is not given.
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen.
8 26x 2 Color Erase These SPs show how many times color creation features
8 26x 3 Background have been selected at the operation panel.
8 26x 4 Other
350
System SP8-xxx
8 281 T:Scn PGS/TWAIN *CTL These SPs count the number of pages scanned using
a TWAIN driver. These counters reveal how the
TWAIN driver is used for delivery functions.
8 291 T:Scan PGS/Stamp *CTL These SPs count the number of pages stamped with
8 302 These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy application. Use
these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size [SP
8-442].
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored from within the
8 306 document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from
within the Copy mode screen. Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning)
and output page size [SP 8-446].
351
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 30x 1 A3
8 30x 2 A4
8 30x 3 A5
8 30x 4 B4
8 30x 5 B5
8 30x 6 DLT
3
8 30x 7 LG -
8 30x 8 LT
8 30x 9 HLT
8 30x
Other (Standard)
254
8 30x
Other (Custom)
255
8 315 These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications
that can specify resolution settings.
Note: At the present time, SP8-311 and SP8-315 perform identical counts.
352
System SP8-xxx
The Fax application does not allow finely-adjusted resolution settings so no count is done for the Fax
application.
When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is counted as
2.
When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are counted for the
application that stored them.
These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the following pages
are not counted as printed pages:
- Blank pages in a duplex printing job.
- Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets.
- Reports printed to confirm counts.
- All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.)
- Test prints for machine image adjustment.
- Error notification reports.
- Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam.
8 391 These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger.
Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are also displayed
in the User Tools display on the copy machine.
353
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
354
System SP8-xxx
8 426 These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing from within the document server mode window at the operation
panel.
8 42x 12 Booklet
8 42x 13 Magazine
These counts (SP8 421 to SP8 427) are especially useful for customers who need to improve their
compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption.
Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page.
Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes:
Booklet Magazine
1 1 1 1
2 2 2 2
3 2 3 2
4 2 4 2
5 3 5 4
6 4 6 4
355
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
7 4 7 4
8 4 8 4
3 8 432
C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt *CTL [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the
copy application.
356
System SP8-xxx
8 44x 1 A3
8 44x 2 A4
8 44x 3 A5
8 44x 4 B4
8 44x 5 B5
8 44x 6 DLT
8 44x 7 LG
8 44x 8 LT
8 44x 9 HLT
357
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all applications.
These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is based on
8 461 feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed rollers. However,
these counts are based on output timing.
Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted.
During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a page printed
on one side counts as 1.
358
System SP8-xxx
8 46x 1 Normal
8 46x 2 Recycled
8 46x 3 Special
8 46x 4 Thick
8 46x 7 OHP
8 46x 8 Other
8 471 3 100%
359
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but performed
remotely with an external network application capable of performing magnification adjustment as
well.
Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are also
counted.
Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the document server
are not counted.
Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying are
3 counted.
The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned a rate of
100%.
These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature switched on.
Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print application.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
8 49x 1 B/W
360
System SP8-xxx
8 50x 1 B/W
8 514 1 RPCS
8 514 2 RPDL
8 514 3 PS3
8 514 4 R98
8 514 5 R16
8 514 6 GL/GL2
8 514 7 R55
8 514 8 RTIFF
8 514 9 PDF
8 514 10 PCL5e/5c
8 514 11 PCL XL
8 514 12 IPDL-C
8 514 14 Other
8 514 15 IPDS
SP8 511 and SP8 514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print application.
361
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 523 These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Fax
application.
NOTE: Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available.
8 52x 1 Sort
8 52x 2 Stack
8 52x 3 Staple
8 52x 4 Booklet
8 52x 5 Z-Fold
8 52x 6 Punch
8 52x 7 Other
8 52x 8 Inside-Fold
8 52x 9
362
System SP8-xxx
8 52x 10
8 52x 11
8 52x 12
8 52x 13
8 52x 14
3
If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled pages are still
counted.
The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries are counted.
8 581 These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless of the
application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are
also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.
8 581 1 Total
8 581 5 Development: K
363
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
These SPs count the total output of the copy application broken down by color output.
8 582 1 B/W
These SPs count the total output of the fax application broken down by color output.
8 583 1 B/W
These SPs count the total output of the print application broken down by color output.
8 584 1 B/W
364
System SP8-xxx
These SPs count the total output of the local storage broken down by color output. 3
8 582 1 B/W
8 591 1 A3/DLT
-
8 591 2 Duplex
8 601 1 B/W
8 601 2 Color
365
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 617 1 SDK1
8 617 2 SDK2
8 617 3 SDK3 These SPs count the total printout pages for each SDK
8 617 4 SDK4 applicaion.
8 617 5 SDK5
3
8 617 6 SDK6
8 63x 1 B/W
8 63x 2 Color
If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/
W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and SP8633 are
the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for
each destination.
Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.
Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.
366
System SP8-xxx
8 64x 1 B/W
8 64x 2 Color
If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/
W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and SP8643 are
the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for
3
each destination.
Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.
Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.
8 65x 1 B/W
8 65x 2 Color
The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If the job is
cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted.
If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10 (the pages are
sent to the same SMTP server together).
If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the document is sent
to each destination of the SMB/FTP server).
Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to a large
number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted separately. For example, if a 10-page
document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is 10 for the first 100 destinations and the count is also
10 for the second 100 destinations, for a total of 20.).
367
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
3 8 66x 1 B/W
8 66x 2 Color
The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the Scan Router
server.
If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are not done.
The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan Router server.
8 67x 1 B/W
8 67x 2 Color
8 681 T:PCFAX TXPGS *CTL These SPs count the number of pages sent by PC Fax.
These SPs are provided for the Fax application only,
so the counts for SP8 681 and SP8 683 are the same.
8 683 F:PCFAX TXPGS *CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the copier to the
destination.
368
System SP8-xxx
When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages are only
counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B. The counter goes
up by 10, not 20.)
8 691 T:TX PGS/LS *CTL These SPs count the number of pages sent from the
document server. The counter for the application that
8 692 C:TX PGS/LS *CTL was used to store the pages is incremented.
8 693 F:TX PGS/LS *CTL [0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
8 694 P:TX PGS/LS *CTL within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File
3
8 695 S:TX PGS/LS *CTL
button from within the Copy mode screen go to the C:
8 696 L:TX PGS/LS *CTL counter.
Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count.
If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted for the
application that stored them.
When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the number of pages
sent to each destination.
8 701 These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to send them. For
example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via ISDN G4, the count for ISDN
(G3, G4) is 12.
8 701 1 PSTN-1
8 701 2 PSTN-2
8 701 3 PSTN-3
8 701 5 Network
8 715 1 JPEG/JPEG2000
369
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 715 2 TIFF(Multi/Single)
8 715 3 PDF
8 715 4 Other
8 715 5 PDF/Comp
x 1 B/W
x 2 Color
x 1 B/W
x 2 Color
8 741 1 PSTN-1
8 741 2 PSTN-2
8 741 3 PSTN-3
8 741 5 Network
370
System SP8-xxx
8 771 1 Total
8 771 2 K
8 771 3 Y
8 771 4 M 3
8 771 5 C
8 781 These SPs display the number of already replaced toner bottles.
NOTE: Currently, the data in SP7-833-011 through 014 and the data in SP8-781-001
through 004 are the same.
These SPs display the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP allows the user
8 801 to check the toner supply at any time.
Note: This precise method of measuring remaining toner supply (1% steps) is better
than other machines in the market that can only measure in increments of 10 (10%
steps).
8 801 1 K
8 801 2 Y
371
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 801 3 M
8 801 4 C
8 861 1 BK
8 861 2 Y
8 861 3 M
8 861 4 C
8 871 1 BK
8 871 2 Y
372
System SP8-xxx
8 871 3 M
8 871 4 C
8 881 1 BK
3
8 881 2 Y
8 881 3 M
8 881 4 C
8 891 1 BK
8 891 2 Y
8 891 3 M
8 891 4 C
8 901 1 BK
8 901 2 Y
8 901 3 M
8 901 4 C
8 911 1 BK
373
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 911 2 Y
8 911 3 M
8 911 4 C
8 921 14 Coverage/P: BK
8 921 15 Coverage/P: Y
8 921 16 Coverage/P: M
8 921 17 Coverage/P: C
8 941 These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each operation mode. These
SPs are useful for customers who need to investigate machine operation for
improvement in their compliance with ISO Standards.
374
System SP8-xxx
Scanner application
8 951 10 Scanner Program registrations with the Program
(job settings) feature.
375
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
8 999 1 Total
8 999 3 Copy: BW
8 999 7 Printer BW
8 999 12 A3/DLT
8 999 13 Duplex
376
Input and Output Check Tables
When entering the Input Check mode, 8 digits display the result for a section. Each digit corresponds to a
different device as shown in the table.
Bit No. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Result 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1 0 or 1
3
Copier
Reading
5803 Description
0 1
377
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
5803 23 HVPS:CB - -
5803 24 HVPS:T - -
Not HP
5803 38 ITB Contact HP Sensor HP (Contact)
(not contact)
378
Input and Output Check Tables
5803 56 DIP SW - -
379
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Models Bit
380
Input and Output Check Tables
A4 SEF A4 SEF 0 1 1
B5 SEF B5 SEF 1 1 0 3
11" x 81/2" LEF*3 A4 LEF*3
0 0 1
(A4 LEF) (11" x 81/2" LEF)
A5 LEF A5 LEF 1 0 1
*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-002
(Tray 1) or SP 5-181-006 (Tray 2).
*2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-003
(Tray 1) or SP 5-181-007 (Tray 2).
*3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-001
(Tray 1) or SP 5-181-005 (Tray 2).
*4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-004
(Tray 1) or SP 5-181-008 (Tray 2).
381
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
1 0 0 1 1 LT LEF A4 LEF
3 *1: The paper size (LT or LG) can be selected with SP1-007-001.
F4
8.5" x 13", 8.25" x 13",
or 8" x 13" 8.5" x 14" O X X O O 00000011
SP 5126 controls the size
that is detected
B5 LEF - O O X X X 00000000
B5 SEF - X X X O X 00000010
5.5" x 8.5",
A5 LEF/ SEF X X X X X 00000000
8.5" x 5.5"
382
Input and Output Check Tables
Models Bit
A4 SEF A4 SEF 1 0 0 0 3
B5 SEF B5 SEF 0 0 1 1
A5 LEF A5 LEF 0 1 0 0
A5 SEF A5 SEF 1 1 0 1
*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-010 (Tray
3) or SP 5-181-014 (Tray 4).
*2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-011 (Tray
3) or SP 5-181-015 (Tray 4).
*3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-009
(Tray 3) or SP 5-181-013 (Tray 4).
*4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-012
(Tray 3) or SP 5-181-016 (Tray 4).
ARDF (D366)
Reading
6007 Description
0 1
6007 1 Original Length Sn1 (B5 Sn) Paper not detected Paper detected
383
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
6007 2 Original Length Sn2 (A4 Sn) Paper not detected Paper detected
6007 3 Original Length Sn3 (LG Sn) Paper not detected Paper detected
Reading
6120 Description
0 1
384
Input and Output Check Tables
385
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Copier
386
Input and Output Check Tables
387
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
388
Input and Output Check Tables
389
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
390
Input and Output Check Tables
391
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
ARDF (D366)
392
Test Pattern Printing
Do not operate the machine until the test pattern is printed out completely. Otherwise, an SC occurs.
1. Enter the SP mode and select SP2-109-003.
2. Enter the number for the test pattern that you want to print and press [#].
3
3. When you want to select the single color of Magenta, Yellow or Cyan for printing a test pattern, select
the color with SP2-109-005 (2: Magenta, 3: Yellow, 4: Cyan).
4. When you want to change the density of printing a test pattern, select the density with SP2-109-006
to -009 for each color.
If you select "0" with SP2-109-006 to -009, the color to be adjusted to "0" does not come up
on a test pattern.
5. When you are prompted to confirm your selection, touch "Yes" to select the test pattern for printing.
6. Touch "Copy Window" to open the copy window, then select the settings for the test print (paper size
etc.).
If you want to use black and white printing, touch "Black & White" on the LCD. If you want to
use color printing, touch "Full Colour" on the LCD.
7. Press the "Start" key to start the test print.
8. After checking the test pattern, touch "SP Mode" on the LCD to return to the SP mode display.
9. Reset all settings to the default values.
10. Touch "Exit" twice to exit SP mode.
393
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
394
Printer Service Mode
bit 0 DFU - - 3
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will never occur.
Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot ( "Card Save
Function" in "System Maintenance" chapter of the Field Service Manual).
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the edges of the
printable area.
395
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not already have a
Collate Type configured.
3
If #5-0 is enabled, this Bit Switch has no effect.
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
396
Printer Service Mode
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as HP4000/HP8000.
In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually "<ESC>*r0A") will be changed
to "<ESC>*r1A" 3
bit 3 DFU - -
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
If enabled, the simplex pages of IPDS jobs will be printed on the front side because of
printing on the back side of the page. This might reduce printing speed.
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
397
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and Punch Type
bit 0 from the operation panel. The available types will depend on the device and configured
options.
After enabling the function, the settings will appear under:
"User Tools > Printer Features > System"
If a paper size or type mismatch occurs during the printing of multiple copies, only a
single copy is output by default. Using this BitSw, the device can be configured to print
all copies even if a paper mismatch occurs.
bit 2 DFU - -
bit 4 Increase max number of the stored jobs to 1000 Disable Enable (1000)
jobs. (100)
Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD via Job
Type settings to 1000. The default is 100.
Enable: All print jobs will be output face-up in the destination tray.
If enabled, the image rotation will be performed as they were in the specifications of
older models for the binding of pages of mixed orientation jobs.
The old models are below:
- PCL: Pre-04A models
- PS/PDF/RPCS:Pre-05S models
398
Printer Service Mode
bit 7 1: Enable
Letterhead mode printing 0: Disable
(Duplex)
bit 0 If enabled, simplex pages (in mixed simplex/duplex PS/PCL5 jobs only) and the last
page of an odd paged duplex job (PS, PCL5, PCL6), are always routed through the
duplex unit. Not having to switch paper paths increases the print speed slightly.
bit 1
DFU - -
to 7
bit 0 DFU - -
bit 1 DFU - -
bit 2 DFU - -
Enable: BW jobs submitted without a user code will be printed even if usercode
authentication is enabled.
bit 4 DFU - -
bit 5 DFU - -
bit 6 DFU - -
bit 7 DFU - -
399
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
"Disabled
PDL Auto Detection timeout of jobs submitted via "Enabled
USB or Parallel Port (IEEE 1284). (Immediatel
(10 seconds)"
y)"
bit 0
To be used if PDL auto-detection fails. A failure of PDL autodetection doesn't necessarily
mean that the job can't be printed. This bit switch tells the device whether to time-out
3 immediately (default) upon failure or to wait 10 seconds.
bit 1 DFU - -
If this bit switch, all jobs will be cancelled after a jam occurs.
Note: If this bitsw is enabled, printing under the following conditions might result in
problems:
- Job submission via USB or Parallel Port
- Spool printing (WIM >Configuration > Device Settings > System)
This bitsw causes the device to revert to the behavior of previous generations. It only
takes effect if "Bypass Tray Setting Priority" = "Driver/Command".
Previous spec (bitsw=1): If a standard sized paper mismatch occurred in the bypass
tray, the MFP always prompted for SEF paper.
If this bitsw=0 (default) then in the event of a standard sized paper mismatch, the MFP
will always prompt for paper of the rotation (SEF/LEF) determined by the MFP bypass
tray paper setting or by the bypass tray sensor.
Bit 4 DFU
- -
to 7
400
Printer Service Mode
Print Summary
1004 1
Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings).
Disp. Version
1005 1
Displays the version of the controller firmware. 3
1006 [Sample/Locked Print] *CTL 0: Linked, 1: On
Enables and disables the document server. When you select "0," the document server is
1006 1 enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service Mode SP5-967. When you select
"1," the document server is enabled regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967.
[Data Recall]
1101 Recalls a set of gamma settings. This can be either a) the factory setting, b) the previous
setting, or c) the current setting.
1101 1 Factory
1101 2 Previous
*CTL
1101 3 Current
1101 4 ACC
[Resolution Setting]
1102
Selects the printing mode (resolution) for the printer gamma adjustment.
2400x600 Photo, 1800x600 Photo, 600 x 600 Photo, 2400x600 Text, 1800x600, Text,
1102 1
600x600 Text
[Test Page]
1103
Prints the test page to check the color balance before and after the gamma adjustment.
401
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
[Gamma Adjustment]
1104
Adjusts the printer gamma for the mode selected in the "Mode Selection" menu.
1105 Stores the print gamma adjusted with the "Gamma Adj." menu item as the current setting.
Before the machine stores the new "current setting", it moves the data currently stored as the
"current setting" to the "previous setting" memory storage location.
[Toner Limit]
1106
Adjusts the maximum toner amount for image development.
402
Printer Service Mode
403
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
Scanner SP Mode
SP1-xxx (System and Others)
1001 5 - *CTL -
3 [Compression Type]
1004
Selects the compression type for binary picture processing.
[1 to 3 / 1 / 1/step ]
1004 1 Compression Type *CTL
1: MH, 2: MR, 3: MMR
[Erase margin]
1005 Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image.
If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. This SP is activated
only when the machine uses TWAIN scanning.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
1009 [Remote scan disable] *CTL
0: enable, 1: disable
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
1010 [Non Display Clear Light PDF] *CTL
0: Display, 1: No display
404
Scanner SP Mode
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
1012 [UserInfo release] *CTL
0: No, 1: Yes
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
1013 [Multimedia Function Setting] *CTL
0: OFF, 1: ON
405
3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables
406